THE BMW 2 SERIES COUPE. - Dealer...

232
Owner's Manual for Vehicle The Ultimate Driving Machine® THE BMW 2 SERIES COUPE. OWNER'S MANUAL. Contents A-Z Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Transcript of THE BMW 2 SERIES COUPE. - Dealer...

Owner's Manualfor Vehicle

The UltimateDriving Machine®

THE BMW 2 SERIES COUPE.OWNER'S MANUAL.

ContentsA-Z

Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Information Provided by:

2 Series Owner's Manual for VehicleThank you for choosing a BMW.The more familiar you are with your vehicle, the better controlyou will have on the road. We therefore strongly suggest:Read this Owner's Manual before starting off in your new BMW.Also use the Integrated Owner's Manual in your vehicle. It con‐tains important information on vehicle operation that will helpyou make full use of the technical features available in yourBMW. The manual also contains information designed to en‐hance operating reliability and road safety, and to contribute tomaintaining the value of your BMW.Any updates made after the editorial deadline for the printed orIntegrated Owner's Manual are found in the appendix of theprinted Quick Reference for the vehicle.Supplementary information can be found in the additional bro‐chures in the onboard literature.We wish you a safe and enjoyable ride.BMW AG

The Owner's Manual is available in many countries as an app.Additional information on the Internet:www.bmw.com/bmw_drivers_guide

Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

© 2015 Bayerische Motoren WerkeAktiengesellschaftMunich, GermanyReprinting, including excerpts, only with the writtenconsent of BMW AG, Munich.US English II/15, 03 15 490Printed on environmentally friendly paper, bleachedwithout chlorine, suitable for recycling.

Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Addendum

ADDENDUM TO OWNER'S MANUALWe wanted to provide you with some updates and clarifications with respect to the printed BMW Owner's Manual. These updates and clarifications will supersede the materials con-tained in that document. 1. Where the terms “service center,” “the ser-

vice center,” “your service center,” “service specialist,” or “service” are used in the Owner's Manual, we wanted to clarify that the terms refer to a BMW dealer's service center or another service center or repair shop that employs trained personnel that can perform maintenance and repair work on your vehicle in accordance with BMW specifications.

2. Where the text of the Owner's Manual con-tains an affirmative instruction to contact a “service center” or “your service center,” we wanted to clarify that BMW recom-mends that, if you are faced with one of the situations addressed by that text, you con-tact or seek the assistance of a BMW dealer's service center or another service center or repair shop that employs trained personnel that can perform maintenance and repair work on your vehicle in accor-dance with BMW specifications. While BMW of North America LLC, at no cost to you, will pay for repairs required by the limited warranties provided with respect to your vehicle and for maintenance under the Maintenance Program during the appli-cable warranty and maintenance coverage periods, you are free to elect, both during those periods and thereafter, to have main-tenance and repair work provided by other service centers or repair shops.

3. Where the Owner's Manual makes refer-ence to parts and accessories having been approved by BMW, those references are intended to reflect that those parts and accessories are recommended by BMW of North America LLC. You may elect to use other parts and accessories, but, if you do,

we recommend that you make sure that any such parts and/or accessories are appropri-ate for use on your vehicle.

4. At page 7, under the warranty section's dis-cussion of homologation, where it states that you “cannot lodge warranty claims for your vehicle there,” the text should read that you “may not be able to lodge warranty claims for your vehicle there.”

5. At page 7, under the “Parts and accesso-ries” section, in the sixth sentence, the word “cannot” should read “does not.”

6. At page 53, in the “Check and replace safety belts” section, the text beginning, “This should only be done by your service center …” should be disregarded and the following text should be read in lieu thereof: “BMW recommends having this work per-formed by a service center as it is important that this safety feature functions properly.”

7. At page 153 under the heading: “Objects within the range of movement of the ped-als” and at page 211 under the heading: “Carpets and floor mats,” the paragraph that begins: “Only use floor mats …” should be disregarded and the following language should be read in lieu thereof: “The manu-facturer of your vehicle recommends that you use floor mats that have been identified by it as appropriate for use in your vehicle and that can be properly fixed in place.”

8. At page 159, under the heading: “Have maintenance carried out,” the sentence beginning, “The maintenance should be carried out …” should be disregarded and the following text should be read in lieu thereof:  “BMW recommends that you have the maintenance carried out by your service center.”

9. At page 172, under the heading “Tire infla-tion specifications,” the sentence begin-ning, “Tire inflation pressure specifications

Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Addendum

apply to approved tire sizes …” should be disregarded.

10. At page 178, under the heading: “Mount-ing,” the paragraph beginning, “Have mounting and balancing …” should be dis-regarded and the following text should be read in lieu thereof: “BMW recommends that you have mounting and balancing per-formed by your service center or a tire mounting specialist.”

11. At page 179, under the heading: “Approved wheels and tires,” the term “Approved” should be disregarded and in lieu thereof, the term “Recommended” should be read in its place. In addition, the text of that sec-tion should be disregarded and the follow-ing text should be read in lieu thereof: The manufacturer of your vehicle strongly suggests that you use wheels and tires that have been recommended by the vehicle manufacturer for your vehicle type; other-wise, for example, despite having the same official size ratings, variations can lead to body contact and with it, the risk of severe accidents. The manufacturer of your vehicle does not evaluate non-recommended wheels and tires to determine if they are suitable for use on your vehicle.

12. At page 183, under the heading: “Snow Chains,” the text should be disregarded and the following text should be read in lieu thereof: Only certain types of fine-link snow chains have been tested by the manufacturer of your vehicle and are determined by the manufacturer of your vehicle to be road safe and are recommended by the manufacturer of your vehicle. Information about recommended snow chains is available from a service center.

13. At page 186, under the heading “Hood,” the sentence beginning, “If you are unfamiliar” should be disregarded.

14. At page 189, under the heading: “Engine oil change,” the text should be disregarded and in lieu thereof should be read as follows:BMW recommends that you have the oil changed at your BMW dealer's service cen-ter or at another service center that has trained personnel that can perform the work in accordance with BMW specifications.

15. At page 191, under the heading: “Service and Warranty Information Booklet for US models and Warranty and Service Guide Booklet for Canadian models,” the second paragraph should be disregarded and the following text read in lieu thereof: The manufacturer of your vehicle recom-mends that you have maintenance and repair performed by your BMW dealer's ser-vice center or another service center or repair shop that employs trained personnel that can perform maintenance and repair work on your vehicle in accordance with BMW specifications. The manufacturer of your vehicle recommends that you maintain records of all maintenance and repair work performed on your vehicle.

16. At page 194 and page 196, where it reads: “Do not perform work/bulb replacement on xenon headlights,” that text should be dis-regarded and in lieu thereof the following text should be read: “Xenon headlight work or replacement can cause serious and fatal injuries.” In the text that follows, where it reads: “[h]ave any work on the xenon light-ing system … ,” the following words should be read as preceding that passage: “It is strongly suggested that you …”

17. At page 200, under the “Battery replace-ment” section, the text should be disre-garded and in lieu thereof the following text should be read: Use of recommended vehicle batteriesThe manufacturer of your vehicle recom-mends that you use vehicle batteries that it has tested and recommends for use in your vehicle; otherwise the vehicle could be

Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Addendum

damaged and systems or functions may not be fully available.After a battery replacement, the manufac-turer of your vehicle recommends that you have the battery registered on your vehicle by a service center to ensure that all com-fort functions are fully available, and that any “check control” messages of these comfort functions are no longer displayed.

Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Information Provided by:

ContentsThe fastest way to find information on a partic‐ular topic or item is by using the index, refer topage 218.

6 Notes

At a glance14 Cockpit18 iDrive27 Voice activation system30 Integrated Owner's Manual in the vehicle

Controls34 Opening and closing48 Adjusting59 Transporting children safely63 Driving76 Displays90 Lights95 Safety112 Driving stability control systems118 Driving comfort130 Climate control137 Interior equipment145 Storage compartments

Driving tips152 Things to remember when driving155 Loading158 Saving fuel

Mobility168 Refueling170 Fuel172 Wheels and tires185 Engine compartment187 Engine oil190 Coolant191 Maintenance193 Replacing components202 Breakdown assistance208 Care

Reference214 Technical data218 Everything from A to Z

Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

NotesUsing this Owner's ManualOrientationThe fastest way to find information on a partic‐ular topic is by using the index.An initial overview of the vehicle is provided inthe first chapter.

Updates made after the editorialdeadlineAny updates made after the editorial deadlinefor the Owner's Manuals are found in the ap‐pendix of the printed Quick Reference for thevehicle.

User's manual for Navigation,Entertainment, CommunicationThe topics of Navigation, Entertainment, Com‐munication and the short commands of thevoice activation system are described in a sep‐arate user's manual, which is also includedwith the onboard literature.

Additional sources ofinformationThe service center will be happy to answer anyother questions you may have.Information on BMW, e.g., on technology, isavailable on the Internet: www.bmwusa.com.

BMW Driver’s Guide App

The Owner's Manual is available in many coun‐tries as an app. Additional information on theInternet:www.bmw.com/bmw_drivers_guide

Symbols Indicates precautions that must be followed

precisely in order to avoid the possibility ofpersonal injury and serious damage to thevehicle.◄ Marks the end of a specific item ofinformation.

Refers to measures that can be taken tohelp protect the environment."..." Identifies display texts in vehicle used toselect individual functions.›...‹ Verbal instructions to use with the voiceactivation system.››...‹‹ Identifies the answers generated by thevoice activation system.

Symbols on vehicle components Indicates that you should consult the

relevant section of this Owner's Manual forinformation on a particular part or assembly.

Vehicle features and optionsThis Owner's Manual describes all models andall standard, country-specific and optionalequipment that is offered in the model series.Therefore, in this Owner's Manual, we also de‐scribe and illustrate features that are not avail‐able in your vehicle, e.g., because of the se‐lected optional features or the country-specificversion.This also applies to safety-related functionsand systems.The respectively applicable country provisionsmust be observed when using the respectivefeatures and systems.For any options and equipment not describedin this Owner's Handbook, refer to the Supple‐mentary Owner's Handbooks.

Seite 6

Notes

6Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

On right-hand drive vehicles, some controlsare arranged differently from what is shown inthe illustrations.

Status of the Owner'sManualBasic informationThe manufacturer of your vehicle pursues apolicy of constant development that is con‐ceived to ensure that our vehicles continue toembody the highest quality and safety stan‐dards. In rare cases, therefore, the features de‐scribed in this Owner's Manual may differ fromthose in your vehicle.

Updates made after the editorialdeadlineAny updates made after the editorial deadlinefor the Owner's Manuals are found in the ap‐pendix of the printed Quick Reference for thevehicle.

For your own safetyWarrantyYour vehicle is technically configured for theoperating conditions and registration require‐ments applying in the country of first delivery -homologation. If your vehicle is to be operatedin a different country it might be necessary toadapt your vehicle to potentially differing oper‐ating conditions and permit requirements. Ifyour vehicle does not comply with the homolo‐gation requirements in a certain country youcannot lodge warranty claims for your vehiclethere. Further information can be obtainedfrom your Service Centre.

Maintenance and repairsAdvanced technology, e.g., the use of modernmaterials and high-performance electronics,requires suitable maintenance and repair work.

Therefore, have this work performed only by aBMW center or a workshop that works accord‐ing to BMW repair procedures with appropri‐ately trained personnel.If work is not carried out properly, there is adanger of subsequent damage and relatedsafety hazards.

Parts and accessoriesBMW recommends using parts and accesso‐ries approved by BMW for this purpose.Your BMW center is the right contact for genu‐ine BMW parts and accessories, other prod‐ucts approved by BMW and related qualifiedadvice.BMW has tested these products for safety andsuitability in relation to BMW vehicles.BMW can assume responsibility for them.However, we cannot assume any responsibilitywhatsoever for parts and accessories that havenot been specifically approved by BMW.BMW cannot evaluate whether each individualproduct from another manufacturer can beused with BMW vehicles without presenting asafety hazard. This guarantee does not applywhen country-specific government approvalhas been granted. Testing of this kind may failto embrace the entire range of potential oper‐ating conditions to which components mightbe exposed on BMW vehicles. Such productscould conceivably fail to comply with BMW'sown stringent quality standards.

California Proposition 65 WarningCalifornia laws require us to state the followingwarning:Engine exhaust and a wide variety of automo‐bile components and parts, including compo‐nents found in the interior furnishings in a vehi‐cle, contain or emit chemicals known to theState of California to cause cancer and birthdefects and reproductive harm. In addition,certain fluids contained in vehicles and certainproducts of component wear contain or emit

Seite 7

Notes

7Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

chemicals known to the State of California tocause cancer and birth defects or other repro‐ductive harm. Battery posts, terminals and re‐lated accessories contain lead and lead com‐pounds. Wash your hands after handling. Usedengine oil contains chemicals that have causedcancer in laboratory animals. Always protectyour skin by washing thoroughly with soap andwater.

Service and warrantyWe recommend that you read this publicationthoroughly. Your vehicle is covered by the fol‐lowing warranties:▷ New Vehicle Limited Warranty.▷ Rust Perforation Limited Warranty.▷ Federal Emissions System Defect War‐

ranty.▷ Federal Emissions Performance Warranty.▷ California Emission Control System Lim‐

ited Warranty.Detailed information about these warranties islisted in the Service and Warranty InformationBooklet for US models or in the Warranty andService Guide Booklet for Canadian models.Your vehicle has been specifically adapted anddesigned to meet the particular operating con‐ditions and homologation requirements in yourcountry and continental region in order to de‐liver the full driving pleasure while the vehicleis operated under those conditions. If you wishto operate your vehicle in another country orregion, you may be required to adapt your ve‐hicle to meet different prevailing operatingconditions and homologation requirements.You should also be aware of any applicablewarranty limitations or exclusions for suchcountry or region. In such case, please contactCustomer Relations for further information.

MaintenanceMaintain the vehicle regularly to sustain theroad safety, operational reliability and the NewVehicle Limited Warranty.

Specifications for required maintenance meas‐ures:▷ BMW Maintenance system▷ Service and Warranty Information Booklet

for US models▷ Warranty and Service Guide Booklet for

Canadian modelsIf the vehicle is not maintained according tothese specifications, this could result in seri‐ous damage to the vehicle. Such damage isnot covered by the BMW New Vehicle LimitedWarranty.

Data memoryMany electronic components on your vehicleare equipped with data memories that tempo‐rarily or permanently store technical informa‐tion about the condition of the vehicle, eventsand faults. This technical information generallyrecords the state of a component, a module, asystem or the environment:▷ Operating mode of system components, fill

levels for instance.▷ Status messages for the vehicle and from

its individual components, e.g., wheel rota‐tion speed/vehicle speed, deceleration,transverse acceleration.

▷ Malfunctions and faults in important sys‐tem components, e.g., lights and brakes.

▷ Responses by the vehicle to special situa‐tions such as airbag deployment or engag‐ing the stability control system.

▷ Ambient conditions, such as temperature.This data is purely technical in nature and isused to detect and correct faults and to opti‐mize vehicle functions. Motion profiles overroutes traveled cannot be created from thisdata. When service offerings are used, e.g., re‐pair services, service processes, warrantyclaims, quality assurance, this technical infor‐mation can be read out from the event andfault memories by the service personnel, in‐

Seite 8

Notes

8Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

cluding the manufacturer, using special diag‐nostic tools. You can obtain further informationthere if you need it. After an error is corrected,the information in the fault memory is deletedor overwritten on a continuous basis.With the vehicle in use there are situationswhere you can associate these technical datawith individuals if combined with other infor‐mation, e.g., an accident report, damage to thevehicle, eye witness accounts — possibly withthe assistance of an expert.Additional functions that are contractuallyagreed with the customer - such as vehicleemergency locating - you can transmit certainvehicle data from the vehicle.

Event Data Recorder EDRThis vehicle is equipped with an event data re‐corder EDR. The main purpose of an EDR is torecord, in certain crash or near crash-like situa‐tions, such as an air bag deployment or hittinga road obstacle, data that will assist in under‐standing how a vehicle’s systems performed.The EDR is designed to record data related tovehicle dynamics and safety systems for ashort period of time, typically 30 seconds orless.The EDR in this vehicle is designed to recordsuch data as:▷ How various systems in your vehicle were

operating.▷ Whether or not the driver and passenger

safety belts were fastened.▷ How far, if at all, the driver was depressing

the accelerator and/or brake pedal.▷ How fast the vehicle was traveling.These data can help provide a better under‐standing of the circumstances in whichcrashes and injuries occur.EDR data are recorded by your vehicle only if anontrivial crash situation occurs; no data arerecorded by the EDR under normal driving

conditions and no personal data, e.g., name,gender, age, and crash location, are recorded.However, other parties, such as law enforce‐ment, could combine the EDR data with thetype of personally identifying data routinely ac‐quired during a crash investigation.To read data recorded by an EDR, specialequipment is required, and access to the vehi‐cle or the EDR is needed. In addition to the ve‐hicle manufacturer, other parties, such as lawenforcement, that have the special equipment,can read the information if they have access tothe vehicle or the EDR.

Vehicle identificationnumber

The vehicle identification number can be foundin the engine compartment.

The vehicle identification number can also befound behind the windshield.

Reporting safety defectsFor US customersThe following only applies to vehicles ownedand operated in the US.If you believe that your vehicle has a defectwhich could cause a crash or could cause in‐jury or death, you should immediately informthe National Highway Traffic Safety Adminis‐tration NHTSA, in addition to notifying BMW ofNorth America, LLC, P.O. Box 1227, West‐

Seite 9

Notes

9Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

wood, New Jersey 07675-1227, Telephone1-800-831-1117.If NHTSA receives similar complaints, it mayopen an investigation, and if it finds that asafety defect exists in a group of vehicles, itmay order a recall and remedy campaign.However, NHTSA cannot become involved inindividual problems between you, your dealer,or BMW of North America, LLC.To contact NHTSA, you may call the VehicleSafety Hotline toll-free at 1-888-327-4236(TTY: 1-800-424-9153); go to http://www.safercar.gov; or write to: Administrator,NHTSA, 400 Seventh Street, SW., Washing‐ton, DC 20590. You can also obtain other in‐formation about motor vehicle safety fromhttp://www.safercar.gov.

For Canadian customersCanadian customers who wish to report asafety-related defect to Transport Canada, De‐fect Investigations and Recalls, may call thetoll-free hotline 1-800-333-0510. You can alsoobtain other information about motor vehiclesafety from http://www.tc.gc.ca/roadsafety.

Seite 10

Notes

10Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Seite 11

Notes

11Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

At a glanceThese overviews of buttons, switches and

displays are intended to familiarize you with yourvehicle. You will also become quickly acquaintedwith the available control concepts and options.

Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

CockpitVehicle features and optionsThis chapter describes all standard, country-specific and optional features offered with theseries. It also describes features that are notnecessarily available in your car, e. g., due to

the selected options or country versions. Thisalso applies to safety-related functions andsystems. The respectively applicable countryprovisions must be observed when using therespective features and systems.

All around the steering wheel

1 Power windows  452 Exterior mirror operation  553 Glove compartment on the driver's

side  146Driver assistance systems

Intelligent Safety  103

Lane departure warning  109

4 Lights

Front fog lights  93

Parking lights  90

Low beams  90

Seite 14

At a glance Cockpit

14Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Automatic headlight con‐trol  91Daytime running lights  91Adaptive Light Control  91High-beam Assistant  92Instrument lighting  93

5 Steering column stalk, leftTurn signal  67

High beams, head‐light flasher  67

High-beam Assistant  92

Roadside parking lights  91

On-board computer  85

6 Steering wheel buttons, leftStore speed  118

Resume speed  118

Cruise control on/off, inter‐rupt  118

Cruise control rocker switch  118

7 Instrument cluster  76

8 Steering wheel buttons, rightEntertainment source

Volume

Voice activation  27

Telephone, see user's manual forNavigation, Entertainment andCommunication

Thumbwheel for selection lists  84

9 Start/stop the engine and switchthe ignition on/off  64

Auto Start/Stop function  65

10 Steering column stalk, rightWiper  68

Rain sensor  69

Clean the windshields and head‐lights  70

11 Horn, total area12 Steering wheel heating  5813 Adjust steering wheel  5714 Unlock hood  186

Seite 15

Cockpit At a glance

15Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

All around the center console

1 Control Display  182 Glove compartment  1453 Ventilation  1354 Hazard warning system  202

Central locking system  39

5 Radio/CD/Multimedia, see user's manualfor Navigation, Entertainment and Commu‐nication

6 Climate control  1307 Controller with buttons  18

8 Parking brake  679 PDC Park Distance Control  120

Rearview camera  123Parking assistant  125

10 Driving Dynamics Control  114

Dynamic Stability Control  112

11 Steptronic transmission selectorlever  71Manual transmission selector lever  71

Seite 16

At a glance Cockpit

16Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

All about the roofliner

1 Intelligent Emergency Re‐quest  202

2 Glass sunroof  46

3 Indicator lamp, front-seat pas‐senger airbag  97

4 Reading lights  93

5 Interior lights  93

Seite 17

Cockpit At a glance

17Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

iDriveVehicle features and optionsThis chapter describes all standard, country-specific and optional features offered with theseries. It also describes features that are notnecessarily available in your car, e. g., due tothe selected options or country versions. Thisalso applies to safety-related functions andsystems. The respectively applicable countryprovisions must be observed when using therespective features and systems.

The conceptThe iDrive combines the functions of manyswitches. Thus, these functions can be oper‐ated from a central location.

Using the iDrive during a tripTo avoid becoming distracted and pos‐

ing an unnecessary hazard to your vehicle'soccupants and to other traffic, never attemptto use the controls or enter information unlesstraffic and road conditions allow it.◀

Control elements at a glanceControl elements

1 Control Display2 Controller with buttons and, depending on

the equipment version, with touchpad

Control Display

Hints▷ To clean the Control Display, follow the

care instructions.▷ Do not place objects close to the Control

Display; otherwise, the Control Display canbe damaged.

▷ In the case of very high temperatures onthe Control Display, e.g. due to intense so‐lar radiation, the brightness may be re‐duced down to complete deactivation.Once the temperature is reduced, e.g.through shadow or climate control system,the normal functions are re-established.

Switching on1. Switch on the ignition.2. Press the controller.

Switch off

1. Press button.2. "Turn off control display"

Controller with navigation systemThe buttons can be used to open the menusdirectly. The controller can be used to selectmenu items and enter the settings.Some iDrive functions can be operated usingthe touchpad on the controller.

Seite 18

At a glance iDrive

18Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

1. Turn.

2. Press.

3. Move in four directions.

Buttons on controller

Press button Function

MENU Open the main menu.

RADIO Opens the Radio menu.

MEDIA Opens the Multimedia menu.

NAV Opens the Navigation menu.

TEL Opens the phone menu.

Press button Function

BACK Displays the previous panel.

OPTION Opens the Options menu.

Controller without navigation systemThe buttons can be used to open the menusdirectly. The controller can be used to selectmenu items and enter the settings.1. Turn.

2. Press.

3. Move in two directions.

Seite 19

iDrive At a glance

19Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Buttons on controller

Press button Function

MENU Open the main menu.

Audio Open audio menu last listenedto, switch between audio me‐nus.

TEL Opens the phone menu.

BACK Open previous panel.

OPTION Opens the Options menu.

Operating conceptOpening the main menu

Press button.

The main menu is displayed.All iDrive functions can be called up via themain menu.

Selecting menu itemsHighlighted menu items can be selected.

1. Turn the controller until the desired menuitem is highlighted.

2. Press the controller.

Menu items in the Owner's ManualIn the Owner's Manual, menu items that can beselected are set in quotation marks, e.g.,"Settings".

Changing between panelsAfter a menu item is selected, e.g., "Radio", anew panel is displayed. Panels can overlap.▷ Move the controller to the left.

Closes current display and shows previousdisplay.Reopens previous display by pressingBACK button. In this case, the currentpanel is not closed.

▷ Move the controller to the right.Opens new display on top of previousscreen.

Seite 20

At a glance iDrive

20Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

White arrows pointing to the left or right indi‐cate that additional panels can be opened.

Display of an opened menuWhen selecting a menu, it generally opens withthe panel that was last selected in that menu.To display the first panel of a menu:▷ Move the controller to the left repeatedly

until the first panel is displayed.▷ Press the menu button on the controller

twice.

Opening the Options menuPress button.

The "Options" menu is displayed.

Additional options: move the controller to theright repeatedly until the "Options" menu isdisplayed.

Options menuThe "Options" menu consists of various areas:▷ Screen settings, e.g., "Split screen".

This area remains unchanged.▷ Control options for the selected main

menu, e.g., for "Radio".▷ If applicable, further operating options for

the selected menu, e.g., "Store station".

Changing settings1. Select a field.

2. Turn the controller until the desired settingis displayed.

3. Press the controller.

Activating/deactivating the functionsSeveral menu items are preceded by a check‐box. It indicates whether the function is acti‐vated or deactivated. Selecting the menu itemactivates or deactivates the function.

Function is activated. Function is deactivated.

TouchpadSome iDrive functions can be operated usingthe touchpad on the controller:

Selecting functions1. "Settings"2. "Touchpad"3. Select the desired function.

▷ "Speller": enter letters and numbers.▷ "Interactive map": viewing the interac‐

tive map.▷ "Browser": enter Internet addresses.▷ "Audio feedback": pronounces entered

letters and numbers.

Entering letters and numbersEntering letters requires some practice at thebeginning. When entering, pay attention to thefollowing:

Seite 21

iDrive At a glance

21Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

▷ For the input of upper/lower case lettersand numbers, it may be necessary to reelvia the controller to the corresponding In‐put mode, refer to page 25, e.g. when thespelling of upper and lower case letters isidentical.

▷ Enter characters as they are displayed onthe Control Display.

▷ Always enter associated characters, suchas accents or periods so that the letter canbe clearly recognized. Possible input de‐pends on the set language. Where neces‐sary, enter special characters via the con‐troller.

▷ To delete a character, slide to the left onthe touchpad.

▷ To enter a blank space, slide to the right inthe center of the touchpad.

▷ To enter a hyphen, slide to the right in theupper area of the touchpad.

▷ To enter an underscore, swipe to the rightin the lower area of the touchpad.

Using interactive map and InternetVia touch-pad move the interactive map in thenavigation system and Internet sites.

Function Controls

Move interactive map orInternet sites.

Swipe into re‐spective direc‐tion.

Enlarge/shrink interactivemap or Internet sites.

Drag in or out onthe touchpad withfingers.

Display the menu or opena link in the Internet.

Tap once.

Changing settingsYou may change control display settings viatouchpad. Swipe left or right accordingly.

Example: setting the clockSetting the clockOn the Control Display:

1. Press button. The main menu is dis‐played.

2. Turn the controller until "Settings" is high‐lighted, and then press the controller.

3. If necessary, move the controller to the leftto display "Time/Date".

4. Turn the controller until "Time/Date" ishighlighted, and then press the controller.

5. Turn the controller until "Time:" is high‐lighted, and then press the controller.

Seite 22

At a glance iDrive

22Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

6. Turn the controller to set the hours andpress the controller.

7. Turn the controller to set the minutes andpress the controller.

Status informationStatus fieldThe following information is displayed in thestatus field at the top right:▷ Time.▷ Current entertainment source.▷ Sound output, on/off.▷ Wireless network reception strength.▷ Phone status.▷ Traffic bulletin reception.

Status field symbolsThe symbols are grouped as follows.

Radio symbols

Symbol Meaning

HD Radio station is being received.

Satellite radio is switched on.

Telephone symbols

Symbol Meaning

Incoming or outgoing call.

Missed call.

Wireless network receptionstrength.Symbol flashes: network search.

Wireless network is not available.

Bluetooth is switched on.

Roaming is active.

Symbol Meaning

Text message was received.

Check the SIM card.

SIM card is blocked.

SIM card is missing.

Enter PIN.

Entertainment symbols

Symbol Meaning

CD/DVD player.

Music collection.

Gracenote® database.

AUX-IN port.

USB audio interface.

Mobile phone audio interface.

Additional symbols

Symbol Meaning

Spoken instructions are turned off.

Split screenGeneral informationAdditional information can be displayed on theright side of the split screen, e.g., informationfrom the on-board comupter.In the divided screen view, the so-called splitscreen, this information remains visible evenwhen you change to another menu.

Seite 23

iDrive At a glance

23Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Switching the split screen on and offOn the Control Display:

1. Press button.2. "Split screen"

Selecting the displayOn the Control Display:

1. Press button.2. "Split screen"3. Move the controller until the split screen is

selected.4. Press the controller or select "Split screen

content".5. Select the desired menu item.

Programmable memorybuttonsGeneral informationThe iDrive functions can be stored on the pro‐grammable memory buttons and called up di‐rectly, e.g., radio stations, navigation destina‐tions, phone numbers and menu entries.Settings are stored for the profile currently inuse.

Without navigation system andtelephoneOnly radio stations can be stored on the but‐tons, refer to user's manual for Navigation, En‐tertainment, Communication.

Saving a function1. Highlight the function via the iDrive.

2. Press and hold the desired button,until a signal sounds.

Running a functionPress button.The function will work immediately.

This means, e.g., that the number is dialedwhen a phone number is selected.

Displaying the button assignmentTouch buttons with bare fingers. Do not weargloves or use objects.The key assignment is displayed at top edge ofscreen.

Deleting the button assignments1. Press buttons 1 and 8 simultaneously for

approx. five seconds.2. "OK"

Seite 24

At a glance iDrive

24Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Deleting personal in thevehicleThe conceptDepending on the usage, the vehicle savespersonal data, such as stored radio stations.These personal data can be permanently de‐leted through iDrive.

General informationDepending on the equipment package, the fol‐lowing data can be deleted:▷ Personal Profile settings.▷ Stored radio stations.▷ Stored Favorites buttons.▷ Travel and computer information.▷ Music collection.▷ Navigation, e.g. stored destinations.▷ Phone book.▷ Online data, e.g. Favorites, cookies.▷ Voice notes.▷ Login accounts.▷ RemoteApp smartphone tethering.Altogether, the deletion of the data can take upto 30 minutes.

Functional requirementData can only be deleted while stationary.

Deleting dataHeed and follow the instructions on the Con‐trol Display.

1. Switch on the ignition.2. "Settings"3. Open "Options".4. "Delete personal data"5. "Continue"6. "OK"

Entering letters and numbersGeneral informationOn the Control Display:

1. Turn the controller: select letters or num‐bers.

2. Select additional letters or numbers ifneeded.

3. "OK": confirm the entry.

Symbol Function

Press the controller: delete the let‐ter or number.

Press the controller for an extendedperiod: delete all letters or numbers.

Switching between cases, letters andnumbersDepending on the menu, you can reel betweenentering upper and lower case, letters andnumbers:

Symbol Function

Enter the letters.

Enter the numbers.

or Tip controller up.

Without navigation system Select the symbol.

Entry comparisonEntering names and addresses: choice is nar‐rowed down with every letter entered and let‐ters may be added automatically.Entries are continuously compared with datastored in the vehicle.▷ Only those letters are offered during input

for which data is available.

Seite 25

iDrive At a glance

25Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

▷ Target search: names of locations may beentered in languages available throughControl Display.

Seite 26

At a glance iDrive

26Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Voice activation systemVehicle features and optionsThis chapter describes all standard, country-specific and optional features offered with theseries. It also describes features that are notnecessarily available in your car, e. g., due tothe selected options or country versions. Thisalso applies to safety-related functions andsystems. The respectively applicable countryprovisions must be observed when using therespective features and systems.

The concept▷ Most functions displayed on the Control

Display can be operated by voice com‐mands via the voice activation system. Thesystem supports you with announcementsduring input.

▷ Functions that can only be used when thevehicle is stationary cannot be used via thevoice activation system.

▷ The system uses a special microphone onthe driver's side.

▷ ›...‹ Verbal instructions in the Owner'sManual to use with the voice activationsystem.

RequirementsVia the Control Display, set a language that isalso supported by the voice activation systemso that the spoken commands can be identi‐fied.Set the language, refer to page 88.

Using voice activationActivating the voice activation system

1. Press button on the steeringwheel.

2. Wait for the signal.3. Say the command.

A command that is recognized by the voiceactivation system is announced and dis‐played in the instrument cluster.

This symbol in the instrument cluster indi‐cates that the voice activation system is active.If no other commands are available, use func‐tion via iDrive.

Terminating the voice activationsystem

Briefly press the button on the steer‐ing wheel or ›Cancel‹.

Possible commandsMost menu items on the Control Display canbe voiced as commands.The available commands depend on the menuthat is currently displayed on the Control Dis‐play.There are short commands for many functions.You may select lists such as phone lists viavoice activation. Read these lists out loud ex‐actly as they show in the respective list.

Having possible commands read aloudYou can have available commands read outloud for you: ›Voice commands‹E. g. if the "Settings" menu is displayed, thecommands for the settings are read out loud.

Seite 27

Voice activation system At a glance

27Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Executing functions using shortcommandsExecute functions on the main menu via shortcommands. It almost doesn't matter whichmenu item is selected, e.g., ›Vehicle status‹.List of short commands for the voice activationsystem, see Navigation, Entertainment, Com‐munication Owner's Manual.

Help dialog for the voice activationsystemCalling up help dialog: ›Help‹Additional commands for the help dialog:▷ ›Help with examples‹: announces informa‐

tion about the current operating optionsand the most important commands forthem.

▷ ›Help with voice activation‹: informationabout the principle of operation for thevoice activation system is announced.

One example: open the tonesettingsVia the main menuThe commands of the menu items are spokenjust as they are selected via the controller.

1. Turn on the Entertainment sound output ifneeded.

2. Press button on the steeringwheel.

3. ›Radio‹4. ›Tone‹

Via short commandThe desired tone settings can also be startedvia a short command.

1. Turn on the Entertainment sound output ifneeded.

2. Press button on the steeringwheel.

3. ›Tone‹

Setting the voice dialogSet system to standard dialog or use a shortversion.The short version of the voice dialog playsback short messages in abbreviated form.

1. "Settings"2. "Language/Units"3. "Speech type:"4. Select setting.

Adjusting the volumeTurn the volume button while giving an in‐struction until the desired volume is set.▷ The volume remains constant even if the

volume of other audio sources is changed.▷ The volume is stored for the profile cur‐

rently in use.

Hints on EmergencyRequestsDo not use the voice activation system to ini‐tiate an Emergency Request. In stressful situa‐tions, the voice and vocal pitch can change.

Seite 28

At a glance Voice activation system

28Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

This can unnecessarily delay the establish‐ment of a phone connection.Instead, use the SOS button, refer topage 202, close to the interior mirror.

Environmental conditions▷ Say the commands, numbers, and letters

smoothly and with normal volume, empha‐sis, and speed.

▷ Always say commands in the language ofthe voice activation system.

▷ Keep the doors, windows, and glass sun‐roof closed to prevent noise interference.

▷ Avoid making other noise in the vehiclewhile speaking.

Seite 29

Voice activation system At a glance

29Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Integrated Owner's Manual in the vehicleVehicle features and optionsThis chapter describes all standard, country-specific and optional features offered with theseries. It also describes features that are notnecessarily available in your car, e. g., due tothe selected options or country versions. Thisalso applies to safety-related functions andsystems. The respectively applicable countryprovisions must be observed when using therespective features and systems.

Integrated Owner's Manualin the vehicleThe Integrated Owner's Manual can be dis‐played on the Control Display. It specificallydescribes features and functions found in thevehicle.

Components of the IntegratedOwner's ManualThe Integrated Owner's Manual consists ofthree parts, which offer various levels of infor‐mation or possible access.

Quick Reference GuideThe Quick Reference Guide provides informa‐tion how to operate the car, how to use basicvehicle functions or what to do in case of abreakdown. This information can also be dis‐played while driving.

Search by imagesImage search provides information and de‐scriptions. This is helpful when the terminol‐ogy for a feature is not at hand.

Owner's ManualSearch for information and descriptions by en‐tering terms selected from the index.

Select components

1. Press button.2. Turn the controller: open "Vehicle info".3. Press the controller.4. Selecting desired range:

▷ "Quick reference"▷ "Search by pictures"▷ "Owner's Manual"

Leafing through the Owner's Manual

Page by page with link accessTurn the controller until the next or previouspage is displayed.

Page by page without link accessScroll through the pages directly while skip‐ping the links.Highlight the symbol once. Now simply pressthe controller to browse from page to page.

Scroll back.

Scroll forward.

Seite 30

At a glance Integrated Owner's Manual in the vehicle

30Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Context help - Owner's Manual to thetemporarily selected functionYou may open the relevant information di‐rectly.

Opening via the iDriveTo move directly from the application on theControl Display to the Options menu:

1. Press button or move the controllerto the right repeatedly until the "Options"menu is displayed.

2. "Display Owner's Manual"

Opening when a Check Controlmessage is displayedDirectly from the Check Control message onthe Control Display:"Display Owner's Manual"

Changing between a function and theOwner's ManualTo reel from a function, e. g., radio, to theOwner's Manual on the Control Display and toalternate between the two displays:

1. Press button or move the controllerto the right repeatedly until the "Options"menu is displayed.

2. "Display Owner's Manual"3. Select the desired page in the Owner's

Manual.

4. Press button again to return to lastdisplayed function.

5. Press button to return to the page ofthe Owner's Manual displayed last.

To alternate permanently between the last dis‐played function and the Owner's Manual re‐peat steps 4 & 5. Opens a new display everytime.

Programmable memory buttons

General informationThe Owner's Manual can be stored on the pro‐grammable memory buttons and called up di‐rectly.

Storing1. "Owner's Manual" Select via the iDrive.

2. Press selected button for morethan 2 seconds.

ExecutingPress button.The Owner's Manual is displayed im‐

mediately.

Seite 31

Integrated Owner's Manual in the vehicle At a glance

31Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

ControlsThis chapter is intended to provide you with

information that will give you complete control ofyour vehicle. All features and accessories thatare useful for driving and your safety, comfort

and convenience are described here.

Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Opening and closingVehicle features and optionsThis chapter describes all standard, country-specific and optional features offered with theseries. It also describes features that are notnecessarily available in your car, e. g., due tothe selected options or country versions. Thisalso applies to safety-related functions andsystems. The respectively applicable countryprovisions must be observed when using therespective features and systems.

Remote control/keyGeneral informationThe vehicle is supplied with two remote con‐trols with integrated key.Every remote control holds a replaceable bat‐tery.You may set the key functions depending onthe optional features and country-specific ver‐sion. For Settings, refer to page 43.The vehicle stores personal settings for everyremote control. Personal Profile, refer topage 35.The remote controls hold information on re‐quired maintenance. Service data in the re‐mote control, refer to page 191

Overview

1 Unlocking2 Locking3 Unlocking the trunk lid4 Panic mode

Integrated key

Press button, arrow 1, and remove the key, ar‐row 2.The integrated key fits the following locks:▷ Driver's door.▷ Glove compartment on the front passenger

side.

The front passenger glove compartment con‐tains a switch for separately securing the trunklid, refer to page 41.

Seite 34

Controls Opening and closing

34Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Replacing the battery

1. Remove integrated key from remote con‐trol.

2. Push in the catch with the key, arrow 1.3. Remove the cover of the battery compart‐

ment, arrow 2.4. Insert a battery of the same type with the

positive side facing up.5. Press the cover closed.

Take the used battery to a recyclingcenter or to your service center.

New remote controlsNew remote controls are available from theservice center.

Loss of the remote controlsLost remote controls can be disabled by yourservice center.

Emergency detection of remotecontrolIt is possible to switch on the ignition or startthe engine in situations such as the following:▷ Interference of radio transmission to re‐

mote control by external sources e.g., byradio masts.

▷ Empty battery in remote control.▷ Interference from radio transmissions

through mobile devices in close proximityto remote control.

▷ Interference of radio transmission bycharger while charging items such as mo‐bile devices in the vehicle.

A Check Control message is displayed if an at‐tempt is made to switch on the ignition or startthe engine.

Starting the engine with emergencydetection of the remote control

Steptronic transmission: if a correspondingCheck Control message appears, hold the re‐mote control, as shown, against the markedarea on the steering column and press theStart/Stop button within 10 seconds whilepressing the brake.Manual transmission: if a corresponding CheckControl message appears, hold the remotecontrol, as shown, against the marked area onthe steering column and press the Start/Stopbutton within 10 seconds while pressing theclutch pedal.If the remote control is not recognized: slightlychange the height position of the remote con‐trol and repeat the procedure.

Personal ProfileThe conceptPersonal Profile provides three profiles, usingwhich personal vehicle settings can be stored.Every remote control has one of these profilesassigned.If the vehicle is unlocked using a remote con‐trol, the assigned personal profile will be acti‐

Seite 35

Opening and closing Controls

35Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

vated. All settings stored in the profile are au‐tomatically applied.If several drivers use their own remote control,the vehicle will adjust the personal settingsduring unlocking. These settings are also re‐stored, if the vehicle has been used in themeantime by a person with a different remotecontrol.Changes to the settings are automaticallysaved in the personal profile.Three personal profiles and a guest profile canbe created.

AdjustingThe settings for the following systems andfunctions are saved in the active profile. Thescope of storable settings is country- andequipment-dependable.▷ Unlocking and locking.▷ Lights.▷ Climate control.▷ Radio.▷ Instrument cluster.▷ Programmable memory buttons.▷ Volumes, tone.▷ Control Display.▷ Navigation.▷ Park Distance Control PDC.▷ Rearview camera▷ Driving Dynamics Control.▷ Driver's seat position, exterior mirror posi‐

tion, steering wheel position.▷ Cruise control.▷ Intelligent Safety.

Profile management

Opening profilesRegardless of the remote control in use a dif‐ferent profile may be activated.

1. "Settings"2. "Profiles"3. Select a profile.▷ All settings stored in the called-up profile

are automatically applied.▷ The called-up profile is assigned to the re‐

mote control being used at the time.▷ If the profile is already assigned to a differ‐

ent remote control, this profile will apply toboth remote controls. It cannot be differen‐tiated anymore between the settings forthe two remote controls.

Renaming profilesA personal name can be assigned to every pro‐file to avoid confusion between the profiles.

1. "Settings"2. "Profiles"3. "Options"4. "Rename current profile"

Resetting profilesThe settings of the active profile are reset totheir default values.

1. "Settings"2. "Profiles"3. "Options"4. "Reset current profile"

Exporting profilesMost settings of the active profile can be ex‐ported.This can be helpful for securing and retrievingpersonal settings, before delivering the vehicleto a workshop, e.g. Profiles can be taken to an‐

Seite 36

Controls Opening and closing

36Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

other vehicle equipped with the Personal Pro‐file function.The following export options are available:▷ Via BMW Online.▷ Via the USB port to a USB device.

Popular file systems for USB devices aresupported. FAT32 and exFAT are the rec‐ommended formats for profile export.Other formats may not support the export.

1. "Settings"2. "Profiles"3. "Export profile"4. BMW Online: "BMW Online"

USB interface: "USB device"

Importing profilesProfiles exported via BMW Online can also beimported via BMW Online.Profiles stored on a USB device can be im‐ported via the USB interface.Existing settings are overwritten with the im‐ported profile.

1. "Settings"2. "Profiles"3. "Import profile"4. BMW Online: "BMW Online"

USB interface: "USB device"

Using the guest profileThe guest profile is for individual settings thatare saved in none of the three personal pro‐files.This can be useful for drivers who are usingthe vehicle temporarily and do not have theirown profile.

1. "Settings"2. "Profiles"3. "Guest"The guest profile cannot be renamed. It is notassigned to the current remote control.

Display profile list during startThe profile list can be displayed during eachstart to select the desired profile.

1. "Settings"2. "Profiles"3. "Options"4. "Display user list at startup"

Using the remote controlNote

Take the remote control with youPeople or animals left unattended in a

parked vehicle can lock the doors from the in‐side. Always take the remote control with youwhen leaving the vehicle so that the vehiclecan then be opened from the outside.◀

UnlockingPress button on the remote control.

▷ All doors, the tailgate, and the fuel filler flapare being unlocked.

▷ Interior lamps and courtesy lamps are acti‐vated. This function is not available, if theinterior lamps were switched off manually.

▷ The welcome lamps are switched on, if thisfunction was activated.

▷ Exterior mirrors folded through convenientclosing are folded open.

You can set how the vehicle is to be unlocked.For Settings, refer to page 43.The alarm system, refer to page 44, is dis‐armed.

Convenient openingPress and hold this button on the re‐mote control after unlocking.

Seite 37

Opening and closing Controls

37Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

The windows and the glass sunroof areopened, as long as the button on the remotecontrol is pressed.

LockingLocking from the outsideDo not lock the vehicle from the outside

with people inside the car, as the vehicle can‐not be unlocked from inside without specialknowledge.◀

The driver's door must be closed.Press button on the remote control.

All doors, the tailgate, and the fuel filler flap arebeing locked.The alarm system, refer to page 44, is armed.

Switching on interior lights andcourtesy lights

Press button on the remote control withthe vehicle locked.

This function is not available, if the interiorlamps were switched off manually.If the button is pressed again within 10 sec‐onds after vehicle was locked, the interior mo‐tion sensor and tilt alarm sensor of the anti-theft warning system, refer to page 45, areturned off. After locking, wait 10 seconds be‐fore pressing the button again.

Panic modeYou can trigger the alarm system if you findyourself in a dangerous situation.

Press button on the remote control forat least 3 seconds.

To reel off the alarm: press any button.

Unlocking the trunk lidPress button on the remote control forapprox. 1 second.

The trunk lid opens slightly, regardless ofwhether the vehicle was previously locked orunlocked.Depending on the features and the countryversion, it is also possible to have door un‐locked. Create the settings, refer to page 43.If the doors were not unlocked, the trunk lid islocked again as soon as it closes.

Do not place the remote control in thecargo area

Take the remote control with you and do notleave it in the cargo area; otherwise, the re‐mote control is locked inside the vehicle whenthe trunk lid is closed.◀

MalfunctionRemote control detection by the vehicle canamong others be malfunctioning under the fol‐lowing circumstances:▷ The battery of the remote control is dis‐

charged. Replace the battery, refer topage 35.

▷ Interference of the radio connection fromtransmission towers or other equipmentwith high transmit power.

▷ Shielding of the remote control due tometal objects.

▷ Interference of the radio connection frommobile phones or other electronic devicesin direct proximity.

Do not transport the remote control togetherwith metal objects or electronic devices.In the case of interference, the vehicle can alsobe unlocked and locked from the outside with‐out remote control, refer to page 39.

For US owners onlyThe transmitter and receiver units comply withpart 15 of the FCC/Federal CommunicationCommission regulations. Operation is gov‐erned by the following:FCC ID:

Seite 38

Controls Opening and closing

38Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

▷ LX8766S.▷ LX8766E.▷ LX8CAS.▷ LX8CAS2.▷ MYTCAS4.Compliance statement:This device complies with part 15 of the FCCRules. Operation is subject to the followingtwo conditions:▷ This device may not cause harmful inter‐

ference, and▷ this device must accept any interference

received, including interference that maycause undesired operation.

Any unauthorized modifications or changes tothese devices could void the user's authority tooperate this equipment.

Without remote controlFrom the outside

Locking from the outsideDo not lock the vehicle from the outside

with people inside the car, as the vehicle can‐not be unlocked from inside without specialknowledge.◀

Remove the key before pulling the doorhandle

Before pulling the outside door handle, removethe key to avoid damaging the paintwork andthe key.◀

Unlock or lock the driver's door via the doorlock using the integrated key, refer to page 34.The other doors must be unlocked or lockedfrom the inside.

Alarm systemThe alarm system is not armed if the vehicle islocked with the integrated key.The alarm system is triggered when the door isopened, if the vehicle was unlocked via thedoor lock.In order to terminate this alarm, unlock vehiclewith the remote control or switch on the igni‐tion, if needed, through emergency detectionof the remote control, refer to page 35.

From the inside

Unlocking and locking

Pressing the central locking system buttonlocks or unlocks the vehicle with the doorsclosed.

The vehicle is not secured against theft whenlocking.The fuel filler flap remains unlocked.

Seite 39

Opening and closing Controls

39Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

In the event of a severe accident, the vehicle isautomatically unlocked. The hazard warningsystem and interior lights come on.

Unlocking and opening

▷ Press the central locking system button tounlock the doors together, and then pullthe door handle above the armrest.

▷ On the door to be opened, pull the doorhandle twice: the first time unlocks thedoor, the second time opens it. The otherdoors remain locked.

Trunk lidOpeningDuring opening, the trunk lid pivots back andup.Ensure that adequate clearance is availablebefore opening.

Opening from the outside

▷ Press button on the trunk lid.

▷ Press button on the remote con‐trol for approx. 1 second.

As the case may be, the doors are also un‐locked. Unlocking with the remote control,refer to page 38.

The trunk lid is unlocked and can be swungupward.

Opening from the insideWith the vehicle is stationary, pressthe button in the driver's footwell.

The trunk lid is unlocked and opens slightly.

Closing

HintsKeep the closing path clearMake sure that the closing path of the

trunk lid is clear; otherwise, injuries may re‐sult.◀

Do not place the remote control in thecargo area

Take the remote control with you and do notleave it in the cargo area; otherwise, the re‐mote control is locked inside the vehicle whenthe trunk lid is closed.◀

Closing

Recessed grips in the interior trim of the trunklid make it easier to pull down the lid.

Seite 40

Controls Opening and closing

40Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Locking separatelyThe trunk lid can be locked separately with theswitch in the glove compartment. If the glovecompartment is locked, the trunk lid cannot beopened.

▷ Trunk lid secured, arrow 1.▷ Trunk lid not secured, ar‐

row 2.

Slide the switch into the arrow 1 position. Thissecures the trunk lid and disconnects it fromthe central locking system.This is beneficial when the vehicle is parkedusing valet service. The infrared remote con‐trol can be handed out without the key.

Emergency unlocking

Pull the handle inside the cargo area.The trunk lid unlocks.

Comfort AccessThe conceptThe vehicle can be accessed without activat‐ing the remote control.All you need to do is to have the remote con‐trol with you, such as in your pants pocket.The vehicle automatically detects the remotecontrol when it is in close proximity or in thecar's interior.

Comfort Access supports the following func‐tions:▷ Unlocking/locking of the vehicle.▷ Convenient closing.▷ Unlocking of the trunk lid separately.▷ Start the engine.

Functional requirements▷ There are no external sources of interfer‐

ence nearby.▷ To lock the vehicle, the remote control

must be located outside of the vehicle.▷ The next unlocking and locking cycle is not

possible until after approx. 2 seconds.▷ The engine can only be started if the re‐

mote control is in the vehicle.

Unlocking

Grasp the door handle on the driver's or frontpassenger door completely, arrow.This corresponds with pressing the button onthe remote control.

Seite 41

Opening and closing Controls

41Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Locking

Touch the surface on the door handle of thedriver's or front passenger door, arrow, withyour finger for approx. 1 second without grasp‐ing the door handle.This corresponds with pressing the button onthe remote control. To save battery power, ensure that the ignitionand all electronic systems and/or power con‐sumers are turned off before locking the vehi‐cle.

Convenient closingMonitor closingMonitor closing to ensure that no one

becomes trapped.◀

Touch the surface on the door handle of thedriver's or front passenger door, arrow, withyour finger and hold it there without graspingthe door handle.This corresponds to pressing and holding the remote control button.

In addition to locking, the windows and theglass sunroof close and the exterior mirrorsfold in.

Separately unlocking the trunk lidPress button on the exterior of the trunk lid.This corresponds to pressing the re‐mote control button.The situation of the doors does not change.

Do not place the remote control in thecargo area

Take the remote control with you and do notleave it in the cargo area; otherwise, the re‐mote control is locked inside the vehicle whenthe trunk lid is closed.◀

MalfunctionRemote control detection by the vehicle canamong others be malfunctioning under the fol‐lowing circumstances:▷ The battery of the remote control is dis‐

charged. Replace the battery, refer topage 35.

▷ Interference of the radio connection fromtransmission towers or other equipmentwith high transmit power.

▷ Shielding of the remote control due tometal objects.

▷ Interference of the radio connection frommobile phones or other electronic devicesin direct proximity.

Do not transport the remote control togetherwith metal objects or electronic devices.In the case of a malfunction, unlock and lockthe vehicle using the buttons of the remotecontrol or using the integrated key, refer topage 39.

Seite 42

Controls Opening and closing

42Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

AdjustingUnlockingThe settings are saved in the active profile, re‐fer to page 35.

Doors1. "Settings"2. "Doors/key"3. Select the symbol.4. Select the desired function:

▷ "Driver's door only"Only the driver's door and the fuel fillerflap are unlocked. Pressing again un‐locks the entire vehicle.

▷ "All doors"The entire vehicle is unlocked.

Trunk lidDepending on optional features and countryversion, this setting is not offered in somecases.

1. "Settings"2. "Doors/key"3. Select the symbol.4. Select the desired function:

▷ "Tailgate"The trunk lid unlocks.

▷ "Tailgate + door(s)"The trunk lid and the doors are un‐locked.

Confirmation signals from the vehicleThe settings are saved in the active profile, re‐fer to page 35.

1. "Settings"2. "Doors/key"3. Deactivate or activate the desired confir‐

mation signals.

▷ "Acoustic sig. lock/unlock"▷ "Flash when lock/unlock"

Automatic lockingThe settings are saved in the active profile, re‐fer to page 35.

1. "Settings"2. "Doors/key"3. Select the desired function:

▷ "Lock if no door is opened"The vehicle locks automatically after ashort period of time if no door isopened.

▷ "Lock after start driving"The vehicle locks automatically afteryou drive off.

Retrieving the seat and mirror settingsThe driver's seat and exterior mirror positionsused last are stored for the remote control cur‐rently in use.When the vehicle is unlocked, these positionsare automatically retrieved if this function wasactivated.

Pinch hazard when moving back the seatIf this function is used, first make sure

that the footwell behind the driver's seat isempty. Otherwise, people might get injured orobjects damaged when the seat is movedback.◀

The adjustment procedure is interrupted:▷ When a seat position switch is pressed.▷ When a button of the seat and mirror mem‐

ory is pressed.

Activating the setting1. "Settings"2. "Doors/key"3. "Last seat position autom."

Seite 43

Opening and closing Controls

43Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Alarm systemThe conceptWhen the vehicle is locked, the vehicle alarmsystem responds to:▷ Opening a door, the hood or the trunk lid.▷ Movements in the interior.▷ Changes in the vehicle tilt, e. g., during at‐

tempts at stealing a wheel or when towingthe car.

▷ Disconnected battery voltage.The alarm system briefly signals tampering:▷ By sounding an acoustic alarm.▷ By switching on the hazard warning sys‐

tem.▷ By flashing the daytime running lights.

Arming and disarming the alarmsystemWhen you unlock or lock the vehicle, eitherwith the remote control or via the Comfort Ac‐cess, the alarm system is disarmed or armed atthe same time.

Door lock and armed alarm systemThe alarm system is triggered when the door isopened, when the vehicle is unlocked via thedoor lock.

Trunk lid and armed alarm systemThe trunk lid can be opened even when thealarm system is armed.After the trunk lid is closed, it is locked andmonitored again when the doors are locked.The hazard warning system flashes once.

Panic modeYou can trigger the alarm system if you findyourself in a dangerous situation.

Press button on the remote control forat least 3 seconds.

To switch off the alarm: press any button.

Indicator lamp on the interior rearviewmirror

▷ The indicator lamp flashes briefly every2 seconds:The system is armed.

▷ The indicator lamp flashes after locking:The doors, hood or trunk lid is not closedproperly, but the rest of the vehicle is se‐cured.After 10 seconds, the indicator lampflashes continuously. Interior motion sen‐sor and tilt alarm sensor are not active.When the still open access is closed, inte‐rior motion sensor and tilt alarm sensor willbe switched on.

▷ The indicator lamp goes out after unlock‐ing:The vehicle has not been tampered with.

▷ The indicator lamp flashes after unlockinguntil the engine ignition is switched on, butno longer than approx. 5 minutes:An alarm has been triggered.

Tilt alarm sensorThe tilt of the vehicle is monitored.The alarm system responds in situations suchas attempts to steal a wheel or when the car istowed.

Seite 44

Controls Opening and closing

44Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Interior motion sensorThe windows and glass sunroof must beclosed for the system to function properly.

Avoiding unintentional alarmsThe tilt alarm sensor and interior motion sen‐sor can be switched off together, such as inthe following situations:▷ In automatic car washes.▷ In duplex garages.▷ During transport on trains carrying vehi‐

cles, at sea or on a trailer.▷ With animals in the vehicle.

Switching off the tilt alarm sensor andinterior motion sensor

Press the remote control button againwithin 10 seconds as soon as the vehicle

is locked.The indicator lamp lights up for approx. 2 sec‐onds and then continues to flash.The tilt alarm sensor and interior motion sen‐sor are turned off, until the vehicle is lockedagain.

Switching off the alarm▷ Unlock vehicle with the remote control or

switch on the ignition, if needed throughemergency detection of remote control, re‐fer to page 35.

▷ With Comfort Access: if you are carryingthe remote control on your person, graspthe driver side or front passenger side doorhandle completely.

Power windowsHint

Take the remote control with youTake the remote control with you when

leaving the vehicle so that children, e.g., can‐not operate the power windows and injurethemselves.◀

Opening

▷ Press the button to the resistancepoint.The window opens while the switch is held.

▷ Press the switch beyond the resist‐ance point.The window opens automatically. Pressingthe switch again stopse the motion.

See also: Convenient opening, refer topage 37, via remote control.

ClosingKeep the closing path clearMonitor closing and make sure that the

closing path of the window is clear; otherwise,injuries may result.◀

▷ Pull the switch to the resistancepoint.The window closes while the switch isheld.

Seite 45

Opening and closing Controls

45Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

▷ Pull the switch beyond the resistancepoint.The window closes automatically. Pullingagain stops the motion.

See also: closing by means of Comfort Access,refer to page 41.

Pinch protection systemDanger of jamming even with pinch pro‐tection

Even with the pinch protection system, checkthat the window's closing path is clear; other‐wise, the closing action may not stop in certainsituations, e.g., if thin objects are present.◀

No window accessoriesDo not install any accessories in the win‐

dow's range of movement; otherwise, thepinch protection system will be impaired.◀

If closing force exceeds a specific margin as awindow closes, closing is interrupted.The window reopens slightly.

Closing without the pinch protectionsystem

Keep the closing path clearMonitor closing and make sure that the

closing path of the window is clear; otherwise,injuries may result.◀

E.g. danger from the outside or ice might pre‐vent window from closing properly - proceedas follows:

1. Pull the reel past the resistance point andhold it there.The pinch protection is limited and thewindow reopens slightly if the closing forceexceeds a certain margin.

2. Pull the reel past the resistance point againwithin approx. 4 seconds and hold it there.The window closes without jam protection.

Glass sunroof, poweredGeneral informationThe glass sunroof is operational when the igni‐tion is switched on.

Keep the closing path clearMonitor closing and make sure that the

closing path of the glass sunroof is clear; oth‐erwise, injuries may result.◀

Take the remote control with youTake the remote control with you when

leaving the vehicle so that children, e.g., can‐not operate the glass sunroof and injure them‐selves.◀

Tilting the glass sunroofPush switch briefly upward.▷ The closed glass sunroof is

tilted.▷ The opened glass sunroof

closes until it is in its tiltedposition. The sliding visordoes not move.

Opening/closing the glass sunroof andsliding visor together

▷ Press the reel in the desireddirection to the resistancepoint and hold it there.Glass sunroof and sliding vi‐sor open together as long asthe reel is held down.

Seite 46

Controls Opening and closing

46Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

The glass sunroof closes aslong as the reel is helddown. The sliding visor canbe manually closed.

▷ Press the reel in the desired direction pastthe resistance point.The glass sunroof and sliding visor openautomatically.The glass sunroof closes automatically.The sliding visor can be manually closed.Pressing the reel upward stops the motion.

Additional options:▷ Convenient opening, refer to page 37, via

the remote control.▷ Closing by means of Comfort Access, refer

to page 41.

Comfort positionIf the glass sunroof is not automatically com‐pletely opened, the comfort position has beenattained. In this position the wind noises in theinterior are the least.If desired, continue the movement by pressingthe reel.

Pinch protection systemIf the closing force when closing the glass sun‐roof exceeds a certain value, the closing move‐ment is stopped, beginning at approximatelythe middle of the opening in the roof, or fromthe tilted position during closing.The glass sunroof reopens slightly.

Danger of jamming even with pinch pro‐tection

Despite the pinch protection system, checkthat the glass sunroof's closing path is clear;otherwise, the closing action may not be inter‐rupted in certain extreme situations, such aswhen thin objects are present.◀

Closing without the pinch protectionsystemE. g. if there is an external danger, proceed asfollows:

1. Press the reel forward beyond the resist‐ance point and hold.The pinch protection is limited and theglass sunroof reopens slightly if the closingforce exceeds a certain margin.

2. Press the reel forward again beyond the re‐sistance point and hold until the glass sun‐roof closes without jam protection. Makesure that the closing area is clear.

Initializing after a power failureAfter a power failure during the opening orclosing process, the glass sunroof can only beoperated to a limited extent.

Initializing the systemThe system can be initialized when the vehicleis stationary and the engine is running.During the initialization, the glass sunroofcloses without jam protection.

Keep the closing path clearMonitor closing and make sure that the

closing path of the glass sunroof is clear; oth‐erwise, injuries may result.◀

Press the reel up and hold it untilthe initialization is complete:▷ Initialization begins within

15 seconds and is com‐pleted when the glass sun‐roof is completely closed.

▷ The glass sunroof closes without jam pro‐tection.

Seite 47

Opening and closing Controls

47Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

AdjustingVehicle features and optionsThis chapter describes all standard, country-specific and optional features offered with theseries. It also describes features that are notnecessarily available in your car, e. g., due tothe selected options or country versions. Thisalso applies to safety-related functions andsystems. The respectively applicable countryprovisions must be observed when using therespective features and systems.

Sitting safelyThe ideal seating position can make a vitalcontribution to relaxed, fatigue-free driving.The seating position plays an important role inan accident in combination with:▷ Safety belts, refer to page 52.▷ Head restraints, refer to page 53.▷ Airbags, refer to page 95.

SeatsHints

Do not adjust the seat while drivingDo not adjust the driver's seat while driv‐

ing, or the seat could respond with unexpectedmovement and the ensuing loss of vehiclecontrol could lead to an accident.◀

Do not incline the backrest too far to therear

Do not incline the backrest too far to the rearwhile driving, or there is a risk of slipping underthe safety belt in the event of an accident. Thiswould eliminate the protection normally pro‐vided by the belt.◀

Keep the movement area unobstructedWhen changing the seat position, keep

the seat's area of movement unobstructed;otherwise, people might get injured or objectsdamaged.◀

Manually adjustable seats

At a glance

1 Forward/backward2 Thigh support3 Seat tilt4 Backrest width5 Lumbar support6 Height7 Backrest tilt

Forward/backward

Pull the lever and slide the seat in the desireddirection.

Seite 48

Controls Adjusting

48Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

After releasing the lever, move the seat for‐ward or back slightly making sure it engagesproperly.

Height

Pull the lever and apply your weight to the seator lift it off, as necessary.

Backrest tilt

Pull the lever and apply your weight to thebackrest or lift it off, as necessary.

Seat tilt

Pull the lever and move the seat to the desiredtilt. After releasing the lever, apply your weight

to the seat or lift it off to make sure the seatengages properly.

Electrically adjustable seats

At a glance

1 Seat and mirror memory2 Backrest width3 Lumbar support4 Backrest tilt5 Forward/backward, height, seat tilt

General informationThe seat setting for the driver's seat is storedfor the profile currently in use. When the vehi‐cle is unlocked via the remote control, the po‐sition is automatically retrieved if the Function,refer to page 43, is activated for this purpose.

Adjustments in detail1. Forward/back.

Seite 49

Adjusting Controls

49Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

2. Height.

3. Seat tilt.

4. Backrest tilt.

Thigh support

Pull the lever at the front of the seat and adjustthe thigh support.

Lumbar supportThe curvature of the seat backrest can be ad‐justed in a way that it supports the lumbar re‐gion of the spine. The lower back and thespine are supported for upright posture.

▷ Press the front/rear sectionof the switch.The curvature is increased/decreased.

▷ Press the upper/lower sec‐tion of the switch.The curvature is shifted up/down.

Backrest widthChange the width of the back‐rest using the side wings to ad‐just the lateral support.

Seite 50

Controls Adjusting

50Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Front seat heating

Switching onPress button once for each tempera‐ture level.

The maximum temperature is reached whenthree LEDs are lit.If the journey is continued within approx. 15minutes, the seat heating is activated automat‐ically with the temperature selected last.When ECO PRO, refer to page 159, is acti‐vated, the heater output is reduced.

Switch offPress button longer.The LEDs go out.

Entering the rear

NoteFolding back and locking the backrestBefore driving off, fold back and lock the

backrests; otherwise, an unexpected seatmovement may cause an accident.◀

Keep the movement area unobstructedWhen changing the seat position, keep

the seat's area of movement unobstructed;otherwise, people might get injured or objectsdamaged.◀

Manual length adjustment

Comfort entryThe comfort entry contains a memory functionfor forward/backward and backrest adjust‐ment.

1. Pull lever up to the stop.

2. Fold backrest forward.3. Push the seat forward.

Original position1. Push the seat back into the original posi‐

tion.2. Fold back the backrest to lock the seat.

Electric forward/backward adjustment

Comfort entryThe comfort entry contains a memory functionfor forward/backward and backrest adjust‐ment.

1. Pull lever up to the stop.

2. Fold backrest forward.3. To change the entry area:

Seite 51

Adjusting Controls

51Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

▷ Press and hold this button untilthe seat has moved to the de‐

sired position. Releasing the buttonstops window/roof movement.

▷ Press button briefly. The seat au‐tomatically moves to the end po‐

sition. Pressing again stops the motion.

Original position1. Moving the seat to its original position:

▷ Press and hold this button untilthe seat has moved to its original

position. Releasing the button stopswindow/roof movement.

▷ Press button briefly. The seatmoves to its original position.

Pressing again stops the motion.2. Folding the backrest back.

Safety beltsSeats with safety beltThe vehicle has four seats, each of which isequipped with a safety belt.

General informationAlways make sure that safety belts are beingworn by all occupants before driving off.For the occupants' safety the belt lockingmechanism triggers early. Slowly guide thebelt out of the holder when applying it.Although airbags enhance safety by providingadded protection, they are not a substitute forsafety belts.The upper shoulder strap's anchorage pointwill be correct for adult seat occupants of ev‐ery build if the seat is correctly adjusted.

HintsOne person per safety beltNever allow more than one person to

wear a single safety belt. Never allow infants orsmall children to ride on a passenger's lap.◀

Putting on the beltLay the belt, without twisting, snugly

across the lap and shoulders, as close to thebody as possible. Make sure that the belt lieslow around the hips in the lap area and doesnot press on the abdomen. Otherwise, the beltcan slip over the hips in a frontal impact and in‐jure the abdomen.The safety belt must not lie across the neck,rub on sharp edges, be routed over breakableobjects, or be pinched.◀

What reduces the restraining effectAvoid wearing bulky clothing, and pull

the shoulder belt periodically to readjust thetension. Make sure that the belt is not jammed;otherwise, the belt can be damaged and therestraining effect is reduced.◀

Buckling the belt

Make sure you hear the latch plate engage inthe belt buckle.

Unbuckling the belt1. Hold the belt firmly.2. Press the red button in the belt buckle.3. Guide the belt back into its roll-up mecha‐

nism.

Seite 52

Controls Adjusting

52Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Safety belt reminder for driver's andpassenger's seat

The indicator lamp lights up and a sig‐nal sounds. Make sure that the safetybelts are positioned correctly. The

safety belt reminder is active at speeds aboveapprox. 6 mph/10 km/h. It can also be activatedif objects are placed on the front passengerseat.

Damage to safety beltsWear and tear after accidents or when dam‐aged otherwise:Have the safety belts, including the safety belttensioners, replaced and have the belt anchorschecked.

Check and replace safety beltsThis should only be done by your service

center; otherwise, this safety feature might notwork properly.◀

Front headrestsCorrectly adjusted head restraintA correctly adjusted head restraint reduces therisk of injury to cervical vertebrae in the eventof an accident.

Adjusting the head restraintAdjust the head restraints of all occupied

seats properly; otherwise, there is an increasedrisk of injury in an accident.◀

HeightAdjust the head restraint so that its center isapproximately at ear level.

DistanceAdjust the distance so that the head restraintis as close as possible to the back of the head.If necessary, adjust the distance by adjustingthe tilt of the backrest.

Adjusting the height

▷ To raise: push.▷ To lower: press button, arrow 1, and push

headrest down.

RemovingOnly remove the head restraint if no one will besitting in the seat in question.

1. Raise the head restraint up against the re‐sistance.

2. Press button, arrow 1, and pull the head re‐straint out completely.

Before transporting passengersReinstall the head restraint before trans‐

porting anyone in the seat; otherwise, the pro‐tective function of the head restraint is unavail‐able.◀

Seite 53

Adjusting Controls

53Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Rear head restraintsCorrectly adjusted head restraintA correctly adjusted head restraint reduces therisk of injury to cervical vertebrae in the eventof an accident.

Adjusting the head restraintAdjust the head restraints of all occupied

seats properly; otherwise, there is an increasedrisk of injury in an accident.◀

HeightAdjust the head restraint so that its center isapproximately at ear level.

Adjusting the height

▷ To raise: push.▷ To lower: press button, arrow 1, and push

headrest down.

Folding down head restraintsExtending/retracting head restraintOnly fold down head restraint if no pas‐

sengers are in the rear. Fold out retractedheadrests again if passengers are being car‐ried in the rear; otherwise, there is increasedrisk of injury in the event of an accident.◀

▷ To lower flaps: press the button, arrow 1,and press down the head restraint, arrow 2.

▷ Fold back up: pull up head restraints.

RemovingOnly remove the head restraint if no one will besitting in the seat in question.

1. Raise the head restraint up against the re‐sistance.

2. Press button, arrow 1, and pull the head re‐straint out completely.

Before transporting passengersReinstall the head restraint before trans‐

porting anyone in the seat; otherwise, the pro‐tective function of the head restraint is unavail‐able.◀

Seite 54

Controls Adjusting

54Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Seat and mirror memoryHints

Do not retrieve the memory while drivingDo not retrieve the memory setting while

driving, as an unexpected movement of theseat could result in an accident.◀

Keep the movement area unobstructedWhen changing the seat position, keep

the seat's area of movement unobstructed;otherwise, people might get injured or objectsdamaged.◀

The conceptTwo driver's seat and exterior mirror positionscan be stored per profile, refer to page 35, andcalled up. Settings for the backrest width andlumbar support are not stored in memory.

At a glance

Storing1. Switch on the ignition.2. Set the desired position.

3. Press button. The LED in the but‐ton lights up.

4. Press selected button 1 or 2 while the LEDis lit. The LED goes out.

If the SET button is pressed accidentally:Press button again.The LED goes out.

Calling up settings

Comfort function1. Open the driver's door.2. Switch off the ignition.3. Briefly press the desired button 1 or 2.The corresponding seat position is performedautomatically.The procedure stops when a reel for adjustingthe seat or one of the buttons is pressed.

Safety mode1. Close the driver's door or reel on the igni‐

tion.2. Press and hold the desired button 1 or 2

until the adjustment procedure is com‐pleted.

Calling up of a seat positiondeactivatedAfter a brief period, calling up stored seat posi‐tions is deactivated to save battery power.To reactivate calling up of a seat position:▷ Open and close the door or trunk lid.▷ Press a button on the remote control.▷ Press the Start/Stop button.

MirrorsExterior mirrors

General informationThe mirror on the passenger side is morecurved than the driver's side mirror.Depending on the vehicle equipment, the mir‐ror setting is stored for the profile currently inuse. When the vehicle is unlocked via the re‐mote control, the position is automatically re‐trieved if this function is active.

Seite 55

Adjusting Controls

55Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

NoteEstimating distances correctlyObjects reflected in the mirror are closer

than they appear. Do not estimate the distanceto the traffic behind you based on what yousee in the mirror, as this will increase your riskof an accident.◀

At a glance

1 Adjusting  562 Left/right, Automatic Curb Monitor3 Fold in and out  56

Selecting a mirrorTo change over to the other mirror:Slide the switch.

Adjusting electricallyThe setting corresponds to the direc‐tion in which the button is pressed.

Saving positionsSeat and mirror memory, refer to page 55.

Adjusting manuallyIn case of electrical malfunction press edges ofmirror.

Automatic Curb Monitor

The conceptIf reverse gear is engaged, the mirror glass onthe front passenger side is tilted downward.This improves your view of the curb and otherlow-lying obstacles when parking, e.g.

Activating

1. Slide the switch to the driver's sidemirror position.

2. Engage selector lever position R.

DeactivatingSlide the switch to the passenger side mirrorposition.

Fold in and outPress button.

Possible at speeds up to approx.15 mph/20 km/h.E. g. this is advantageous▷ In car washes.▷ In narrow streets.▷ For folding mirrors back out that were

folded away manually.Mirrors that were folded in are folded out auto‐matically at a speed of approx.25 mph/40 km/h.

Fold in the mirror in a car washBefore washing the car in an automatic

car wash, fold in the exterior mirrors by hand orwith the button; otherwise, the mirrors couldbe damaged, depending on the width of thevehicle.◀

Automatic heatingBoth exterior mirrors are automatically heatedwhenever the engine is running.

Seite 56

Controls Adjusting

56Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Automatic dimming featureBoth exterior mirrors are automatically dim‐med. Photocells are used to control the Interiorrearview mirror, refer to page 57.

Interior rearview mirror, manuallydimmable

Flip lever

To reduce the blinding effect of the interiorrear view mirror, flip the lever forward.

Turn knob

Turn the knob to reduce the blinding effect bythe interior mirror.

Interior rearview mirror, automaticdimming feature

The concept

Photocells are used for control:▷ In the mirror glass.▷ On the back of the mirror.

Functional requirementFor proper operation:▷ Keep the photocells clean.▷ Do not cover the area between the inside

rearview mirror and the windshield.

Steering wheelNote

Do not adjust while drivingDo not adjust the steering wheel while

driving; otherwise, an unexpected movementcould result in an accident.◀

Seite 57

Adjusting Controls

57Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Adjusting

1. Fold the lever down.2. Move the steering wheel to the preferred

height and angle to suit your seating posi‐tion.

3. Fold the lever back.

Steering wheel heating

Press button.

▷ On: the LED lights up.▷ Off: the LED goes out.

Seite 58

Controls Adjusting

58Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Transporting children safelyVehicle features and optionsThis chapter describes all standard, country-specific and optional features offered with theseries. It also describes features that are notnecessarily available in your car, e. g., due to

the selected options or country versions. Thisalso applies to safety-related functions andsystems. The respectively applicable countryprovisions must be observed when using therespective features and systems.

The right place for childrenNote

Children in the vehicleDo not leave children unattended in the

vehicle; otherwise, they could endanger them‐selves and other persons, e.g., by opening thedoors.◀

Children should always be in the rearAccident research shows that the safest placefor children is in the back seat.

Transporting children in the rearOnly transport children younger than

13 years of age or shorter than 5 ft/150 cm inthe rear in child restraint systems provided inaccordance with the age, weight and size ofthe child; otherwise, there is an increased riskof injury in an accident.Children 13 years of age or older must wear asafety belt as soon as a suitable child restraintsystem can no longer be used due to their age,weight and size.◀

Children on the front passenger seatShould it ever be necessary to use a child re‐straint system in the front passenger seat,make sure that the front, knee and side airbagson the front passenger side are deactivated.Automatic deactivation of front-seat passen‐ger airbags, refer to page 97.

NoteDeactivating the front-seat passengerairbags

If a child restraint system is used in the frontpassenger seat, deactivate the front-seat pas‐senger airbags; otherwise, there is an in‐creased risk of injury to the child when the air‐bags are activated, even with a child restraintsystem.◀

Installing child restraintsystemsHints

Manufacturer's information for child re‐straint systems

To select, mount and use child restraint sys‐tems, observe the information provided by thesystem manufacturer; otherwise, the protec‐tive effect can be lost.◀

Ensuring the stability of the child seatWhen installing child restraint systems,

make sure that the child seat is securely fas‐tened to the backrest of the seat. Angle andheadrest of the backrest might need to be ad‐justed or possibly be removed. Make sure thatall backrests are securely locked. Otherwisethe stability of the child seat can be affected,and there is an increased risk of injury because

Seite 59

Transporting children safely Controls

59Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

of unexpected movement of the seat back‐rest.◀

On the front passenger seat

Deactivating airbagsDeactivating the front-seat passengerairbags

If a child restraint system is used in the frontpassenger seat, deactivate the front-seat pas‐senger airbags; otherwise, there is an in‐creased risk of injury to the child when the air‐bags are activated, even with a child restraintsystem.◀

After installing a child restraint system in thefront passenger seat, make sure that the front,knee and side airbags on the front passengerside are deactivated.Deactivate the front-seat passenger airbagsautomatically, refer to page 97.

Seat position and heightBefore installing a child restraint system, movethe front passenger seat as far back as possi‐ble and adjust its height to the highest andthus best possible position for the belt and tooffer optimal protection in the event of an acci‐dent.If the upper anchorage of the safety belt is lo‐cated in front of the belt guide of the child seat,move the passenger seat carefully forward un‐til the best possible belt guide position isreached.

Backrest widthBackrest width for the child seatBefore installing a child restraint system

in the front passenger seat, the backrest widthmust be opened completely. Do not change

the adjustment after this; otherwise, the stabil‐ity of the child seat will be reduced.◀

Adjustable backrest width: before installing achild restraint system in the front passengerseat, open the backrest width completely. Donot change the backrest width again and donot call up a memory position.

Child seat security

The rear safety belts and the front passengersafety belt can be permanently locked to fas‐ten child restraint systems.The front passenger safety belt can be perma‐nently locked to fasten child restraint systems.

Locking the safety belt1. Pull out the strap completely.2. Secure the child restraint system with the

belt.3. Allow the strap to be pulled in and pull it

tight against the child restraint system.The safety belt is locked.

Unlocking the safety belt1. Unbuckle the belt buckle.2. Remove the child restraint system.3. Allow the strap to be pulled in completely.

Seite 60

Controls Transporting children safely

60Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

LATCH child restraint systemLATCH: Lower Anchors and Tether for Chil‐dren.

NoteFollow manufacturer's information forLATCH child restraint systems

To mount and use the LATCH child restraintsystems, observe the operating and safety in‐formation from the system manufacturer; oth‐erwise, the level of protection may be re‐duced.◀

Mounts for the lower LATCH anchorsThe lower anchors may be used to attach theCRS to the vehicle seat up to a combined childand CRS weight of 65 lb/30 kg when the childis restrained by the internal harnesses.

NoteProperly engage the lower LATCH an‐chors

Make sure that the lower LATCH anchors haveproperly engaged and that the child restraintsystem is resting snugly against the backrest;otherwise, the degree of protection may be re‐duced.◀

PositionThe corresponding symbol shows themounts for the lower LATCH anchors.Seats equipped with lower anchors aremarked with a pair, 2, of LATCH sym‐bols. It is not recommended to use theinner lower anchors of standard outer

LATCH positions to fasten a child restraintsystem on the middle seat. Use the vehicleseat belt instead for the middle seat.

Before installing LATCH childrestraint systemsPull the belt away from the area of the child re‐straint system.

Assembly of LATCH child restraintsystems1. Mount the child restraint system; refer to

the user's manual of the system.2. Ensure that both LATCH anchors are prop‐

erly connected.

Child restraint fixing system with atether strap

Mounting pointsThe respective symbol shows the an‐chor for the upper retaining strap.Seats with an upper Top Tether are

marked with this symbol. It can be found onthe rear seat backrest or the rear window shelf.

NoteMounting eyeletsUse the mounting eyes only for the up‐

per retaining strap to secure child restraintsystems; otherwise, the mounting eyes couldbe damaged.◀

Retaining strap guideRetaining strapMake sure the upper retaining strap does

not run over sharp edges and is not twisted asit passes to the top anchor. Otherwise, thestrap will not properly secure the child restraintsystem in the event of an accident.◀

Seite 61

Transporting children safely Controls

61Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

1 Direction of travel2 Head restraint3 Hook for upper retaining strap4 Mounting point/eye5 Rear window shelf6 Seat backrest7 Upper retaining strap

Attaching the upper retaining strap tothe mounting point1. Remove the mounting point cover.2. Raise the head restraint.3. Guide the upper retaining strap between

the supports of the head restraint.4. Attach the hook of the retaining strap to

the mounting eye.5. Tighten the retaining strap by pulling it

down.6. Lower and lock head restraints as needed.

Seite 62

Controls Transporting children safely

62Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

DrivingVehicle features and optionsThis chapter describes all standard, country-specific and optional features offered with theseries. It also describes features that are notnecessarily available in your car, e. g., due tothe selected options or country versions. Thisalso applies to safety-related functions andsystems. The respectively applicable countryprovisions must be observed when using therespective features and systems.

Start/Stop buttonThe concept

Pressing the Start/Stop buttonswitches the ignition on or offand starts the engine.Steptronic transmission: Theengine starts if the brakes are

stepped on while pressing the Start/Stop but‐ton.Manual transmission: The engine starts withthe clutch pedal pressed when the Start/Stopbutton is pressed.

Ignition onSteptronic transmission: Press the Start/Stopbutton without stepping on the brake.Manual transmission: Press the Start/Stop but‐ton without stepping on the clutch pedal.All vehicle systems are ready for operation.Most of the indicator and warning lights in theinstrument cluster light up for a varied lengthof time.To save battery power when the engine is off,switch off the ignition and any unnecessaryelectronic systems/power consumers.

Ignition offSteptronic transmission: Press the Start/Stopbutton again without stepping on the brake.Manual transmission: Press the Start/Stop but‐ton again without stepping on the clutch pedal.All indicator lights in the instrument cluster goout.To save battery power when the engine is off,switch off the ignition and any unnecessaryelectronic systems/power consumers.

P when the ignition is switched offP is engaged automatically when the ig‐

nition is switched off. When in an automatic carwash, e.g., ensure that the ignition is notswitched off accidentally.◀

The ignition automatically cuts off while thevehicle is stationary and the engine is stopped:▷ When locking the vehicle, and when the

low beams are activated.▷ Shortly before the battery is discharged

completely, so that the engine can still bestarted. This function is only availablewhen the low beams are turned off.

▷ When opening or closing the driver door, ifthe driver's safety belt is unbuckled andthe low beams are turned off.

▷ While the driver's safety belt is unbuckledwith driver's door open and low beams off.

The low beams switch to parking lights afterapprox. 15 minutes of no use.

Radio ready stateActivate radio-ready state:▷ When the engine is running: press the

Start/Stop button.Some electronic systems/power consumersremain ready for operation.

Seite 63

Driving Controls

63Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

The radio-ready state switches off automati‐cally:▷ After approx. 8 minutes.▷ When the vehicle is locked using the cen‐

tral locking system.▷ Shortly before the battery is discharged

completely, so that the engine can still bestarted.

The radio-ready state remains active if, e.g.,the ignition is automatically switched off for thefollowing reasons:▷ Opening or closing the driver's door.▷ Unfastening of the driver's safety belt.▷ When automatically switching from low

beams to parking lights.If the engine is switched off and the ignition isswitched on, the system automaticallyswitches to the radio-ready state if the lightsare turned off or, if correspondingly equipped,the daytime running lights are activated.

Starting the engineHints

Enclosed areasDo not let the engine run in enclosed

areas, since breathing in exhaust fumes maylead to loss of consciousness and death. Theexhaust gases contain carbon monoxide, anodorless and colorless but highly toxic gas.◀

Unattended vehicleDo not leave the vehicle unattended with

the engine running; doing so poses a risk ofdanger.Before leaving the vehicle with the engine run‐ning, set the parking brake and place the trans‐mission in selector lever position P or N to pre‐vent the vehicle from moving.◀

Repeated starting in quick successionAvoid trying to start the vehicle repeat‐

edly and in quick succession. Otherwise, thefuel is not burned or is inadequately burned,posing a risk of overheating and damage to thecatalytic converter.◀

Do not wait for the engine to warm-up whilethe vehicle remains stationary. Start driving atmoderate engine speeds.

Steptronic transmission

Starting the engine1. Depress the brake pedal.2. Press the Start/Stop button.The ignition is activated automatically for acertain time and is stopped as soon as the en‐gine starts.

Manual transmission

Starting the engine1. Depress the brake pedal.2. Press on the clutch pedal and shift to neu‐

tral.3. Press the Start/Stop button.The ignition is activated automatically for acertain time and is stopped as soon as the en‐gine starts.

Engine stopHints

Take the remote control with youTake the remote control with you when

leaving the vehicle so that children, e.g., can‐not start the engine.◀

Apply parking brake and further securethe vehicle if needed.

Set the parking brake firmly when parking; oth‐erwise, the vehicle could roll. On steep upward

Seite 64

Controls Driving

64Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

and downward inclines, further secure the ve‐hicle, e.g., by turning the steering wheel in thedirection of the curb.◀

Before driving into a car washSo that the vehicle can roll into a car wash ob‐serve instructions for going into an automaticcar wash, refer to page 208.

Steptronic transmission

Switching off the engine1. Engage selector lever position P with the

vehicle stopped.2. Press the Start/Stop button.

The engine is switched off.The radio-ready state is switched on.

3. Set the parking brake.

Manual transmission

Switching off the engine1. With the vehicle at a standstill, press the

Start/Stop button.2. Shift into first gear or reverse.3. Set the parking brake.

Auto Start/Stop functionThe conceptThe Auto Start/Stop function helps save fuel.The system switches off the engine during astop, e.g., in traffic congestion or at trafficlights. The ignition remains switched on. Theengine starts again automatically for drivingoff.

Automatic modeAfter every start of the engine using the Start/Stop button, the Auto Start/Stop function is inthe last selected state, refer to page 66.When the Auto Start/Stop function is active, it

is available when the vehicle is traveling fasterthan about 3 mph, approx. 5 km/h.

Engine stopThe engine is switched off automatically dur‐ing a stop under the following conditions:Steptronic transmission:▷ The selector lever is in selector lever posi‐

tion D.▷ Brake pedal remains depressed while the

vehicle is stopped.▷ The driver's safety belt is buckled or the

driver's door is closed.Manual transmission:▷ Neutral is engaged and the clutch pedal is

not pressed.▷ The driver's safety belt is buckled or the

driver's door is closed.The air flow from the air conditioner is reducedwhen the engine is switched off.

Displays in the instrument clusterThe READY display in the tach‐ometer signals that the AutoStart/Stop function is ready tostart the engine automatically.

The display indicates that theconditions for an automatic en‐gine stop have not been met.

Functional limitationsThe engine is not switched off automatically inthe following situations:▷ External temperature too low.▷ The external temperature is high and auto‐

matic climate control is running.▷ The car's interior has not yet been heated

or cooled to the required level.

Seite 65

Driving Controls

65Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

▷ The engine is not yet at operating temper‐ature.

▷ The wheels are at a sharp angle or thesteering wheel is being turned.

▷ After driving in reverse.▷ Fogging of the windows when the auto‐

matic climate control is switched on.▷ Vehicle battery is heavily discharged.▷ At higher elevations.▷ The engine compartment lid is unlocked.▷ The parking assistant is activated.▷ Stop-and-go traffic.▷ The selector lever is in position N, M/S or

R.▷ Use of fuel with high ethanol content.

Starting the engineThe engine starts automatically under the fol‐lowing conditions:▷ Steptronic transmission:

By releasing the brake pedal.▷ Manual transmission:

The clutch pedal is pressed.After the engine starts, accelerate as usual.

Safety modeAfter the engine switches off automatically, itwill not start again automatically if any one ofthe following conditions are met.▷ The driver's safety belt is unbuckled and

the driver's door is open.▷ The hood was unlocked.Some indicator lights light up for a variedlength of time.The engine can only be started via the Start/Stop button.

Functional limitationsEven if driving off was not intended, the deacti‐vated engine starts up automatically in the fol‐lowing situations:▷ Excessive warming of the car's interior

when the cooling function is switched on.▷ The steering wheel is turned.▷ Steptronic transmission: change from se‐

lector lever position D to R, N or M/S.▷ Steptronic transmission: change from se‐

lector lever position P to N, D, R or M/S.▷ The vehicle begins rolling.▷ Fogging of the windows when the auto‐

matic climate control is switched on.▷ Vehicle battery is heavily discharged.▷ Excessive cooling of the car's interior when

the heating is switched on.▷ Low brake vacuum pressure; this can oc‐

cur, e.g., if the brake pedal is depressed anumber of times in succession.

Activating/deactivating the systemmanually

Using the button

Press button.

▷ LED comes on: Auto Start/Stop function isdeactivated.The engine is started during an automaticengine stop.The engine can only be stopped or startedvia the Start/Stop button.

Seite 66

Controls Driving

66Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

▷ LED goes out: Auto Start/Stop function isactivated.

Switching off the vehicle during anautomatic engine stopDuring an automatic engine stop, the vehiclecan be switched off permanently, e. g., whenleaving it.

1. Press the Start/Stop button. The ignition isswitched off. The Auto Start/Stop functionis deactivated.Selector lever position P is engaged auto‐matically.

2. Set the parking brake.Engine start as usual via Start/Stop button.

Automatic deactivationIn certain situations, Auto Start/Stop functionis deactivated automatically for safety reasonsas if the driver were absent.

MalfunctionThe Auto Start/Stop function no longerswitches off the engine automatically. A CheckControl message is displayed. It is possible tocontinue driving. Have the system checked.

Parking brakeApplyingThe lever automatically engages after beingpulled up.

The indicator lamp lights up red. Theparking brake is set.Lower lamp: indicator lamp in Canadianmodels

Releasing

Raise lever slightly, press the button and guidethe lever down.

HintsUse while drivingOn rare occasions if it is necessary to use

the parking brake while driving, do not use ex‐cessive force when applying it. When using it,keep the button on the lever depressed.Otherwise, using excessive force when apply‐ing the parking brake may cause the rearwheels to lock, resulting in fishtailing.◀

To prevent corrosion and one-sided brake ac‐tion, lightly apply the parking brake periodicallywhile coasting, if traffic conditions permit.The brake lights will not light up if the parkingbrake is set.

Turn signal, high beams,headlight flasherTurn signal

Do not adjust the exterior mirrorsDo not adjust the exterior mirror while

driving and when turn signals/hazard warningflashers are on, or else the additional turn sig‐nal lights in the exterior mirror are out of posi‐tion and can't be seen.◀

Seite 67

Driving Controls

67Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Using turn signals

Press the lever beyond the resistance point.To switch off manually, press the lever to theresistance point.

Unusually rapid flashing of the indicator lampindicates that a turn signal bulb has failed.

Triple turn signal activationPress the lever to the resistance point.The turn signal flashes three times.The function can be activated or deactivated:

1. "Settings"2. "Lighting"3. "Triple turn signal"Settings are stored for the profile currently inuse.

Signaling brieflyPress the lever to the resistance point and holdit there for as long as you want the turn signalto flash.

High beams, headlight flasher

▷ High beams, arrow 1.▷ Headlight flasher, arrow 2.

Washer/wiper systemSwitching the wipers on/off and briefwipe

HintsDo not activate wipers if frozen to wind‐shield

Do not switch on the wipers if they are frozento the windshield; otherwise, the wiper bladesand the wiper motor may be damaged.◀

Do not activate wipers on dry windshieldDo not use the wipers if the windshield is

dry, as this may damage the wiper blades orcause them to become worn more quickly.◀

Switching on

Push wiper lever up.

Seite 68

Controls Driving

68Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

The lever automatically returns to its initial po‐sition when released.▷ Normal wiper speed: push up once.

The wipers switch to intermittent operationwhen the vehicle is stationary.

▷ Fast wiper speed: press up twice or pressonce beyond the resistance point.Wipers change to normal speed when ve‐hicle comes to standstill.

Switch off and brief wipe

Push wiper lever down.The lever automatically returns to its initial po‐sition when released.▷ Single wipe: press down once.▷ To switch off normal wipe: press down

once.▷ To switch off fast wipe: press down twice.

Interval mode or rain sensor

The conceptThe rain sensor automatically controls the timebetween wipes depending on the intensity ofthe rainfall. The sensor is located on the wind‐shield, directly behind the interior rearview mir‐ror.

Activating/deactivating

Press button on the wiper lever.Wiping is started. If the vehicle is equippedwith a rain sensor: LED in wiper lever lights up.When wipers are frozen to windshield, wiperoperation is deactivated.

Deactivate the rain sensor in car washesDeactivate the rain sensor when passing

through an automatic car wash; otherwise, un‐intentional wiping can cause damages.◀

Setting the frequency or sensitivity ofthe rain sensor

Turn the thumbwheel.

Seite 69

Driving Controls

69Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Clean the windshield, headlights

Pull the wiper lever towards you.The system sprays washer fluid on the wind‐shield and activates the wipers briefly.

In addition, the headlights are cleaned at regu‐lar intervals when the vehicle's lights are acti‐vated.

Do not use the washer system at freezingtemperatures

Do not use the washers if fluid could freezeonto the windshield which might impede yourviewing field. Therefore use antifreeze fluid.Avoid using the washer when the reservoir isempty; operation might damage pump.◀

Windshield washer nozzlesThe windshield washer nozzles are automati‐cally heated while the ignition is switched on.

Fold-out position of the wipersFold wipers back when you want to change theblades or with pending low temperatures.

1. Switch the ignition on and off again.2. With icy conditions make sure that blades

are not frozen to the windshield.3. Press the wiper lever up beyond the point

of resistance and hold it for approx. 3 sec‐onds, until the wiper remains in a nearlyvertical position.

After the wipers are folded back down, thewiper system must be reactivated.

Folding wipers back downBefore switching the ignition on, fold the

wipers back down to the windshield; other‐wise, the wipers may become damaged whenthey are activated.◀

1. Switch on the ignition.2. Push wiper lever down. Wipers move to

their resting position and are ready againfor operation.

Washer fluidHints

Antifreeze for washer fluidAntifreeze is flammable and can cause

injury if it is used incorrectly.Therefore, keep it away from possible sourcesof ignition.Only keep it in the closed original containerand inaccessible to children.Follow the notes and instructions on the con‐tainer.United States: The washer fluid mixture ratio isregulated by the U.S. EPA and many individualstates; do not exceed the allowable washerfluid dilution ratios limits that apply. Follow theusage instructions on the washer fluid con‐tainer. Use BMW’s Windshield Washer Con‐centrate or the equivalent.◀

Adding washer fluidOnly add washer fluid when the engine is

cool, and then close the cover completely toavoid contact between the washer fluid andhot engine parts.Otherwise, there is a danger of fire and a risk topersonal safety if the fluid is spilled.◀

Seite 70

Controls Driving

70Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Washer fluid reservoir

All washer nozzles are supplied from one res‐ervoir.Fill with a mixture of windshield washer con‐centrate and tap water and – if required – with awasher antifreeze, according to the manufac‐turer's recommendations.Mix the washer fluid before adding to find theright mixture.Do not add windshield washer concentrate andantifreeze undiluted and do not fill with purewater; this could damage the wiper system.Do not mix window washer concentrates of dif‐ferent manufacturers because they can clogthe windshield washer nozzles.Recommended minimum fill quantity:0.2 US gal/1 liter.

Manual transmissionShifting

Shifting into 5th or 6th gearWhen shifting into 5th or 6th gear, push

the gearshift lever to the right; otherwise, inad‐vertent shifting into 3rd or 4th gear could leadto engine damage.◀

Reverse gearSelect only when the vehicle is stationary.To overcome the resistance push the selectorlever dynamically to the left and engage the re‐verse gear.

Steptronic transmissionSelector lever positions

D DriveSelector lever position for normal vehicle oper‐ation. All gears for forward travel are activatedautomatically.

R is ReverseSelect only when the vehicle is stationary.

N Neutral:The vehicle may roll. Use in automatic carwashes, e.g.When the ignition is switched off, refer topage 63, selector lever position P is engagedautomatically.

P ParkSelect only when the vehicle is stationary. Thedrive wheels are blocked.P is engaged automatically:▷ After the engine is switched off when the

vehicle is in radio-ready state, refer topage 63, or when the ignition is switchedoff, refer to page 63, and when selectorlever position R or D is set.

▷ With the ignition off, if selector lever posi‐tion N is set.

▷ If the driver's safety belt is released, thedriver's door is opened, and the brakepedal is not pressed while the vehicle isstationary and selector lever position D orR is set.

Before exiting the vehicle, make sure that se‐lector lever position P is set. Otherwise, the ve‐hicle may begin to move.

KickdownKickdown is used to achieve maximum drivingperformance. Step on the accelerator pedal

Seite 71

Driving Controls

71Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

beyond the resistance point at the full throttleposition.

Engaging selector lever positionsPress on the brake pedal until you startdriving

To prevent the vehicle from creeping after youselect a gear, maintain pressure on the brakepedal until you are ready to start.◀

▷ It is not possible to shift out of selectorlever position P until the engine is runningand the brake is applied.

▷ With the vehicle is stationary, press on thebrake pedal before shifting out of P or N;otherwise, the shift command will not beexecuted: shift lock.

Engaging D, R and N

Briefly push the selector lever in the desired di‐rection, beyond a resistance point if needed.After releasing the selector lever, it returns toits center position.

Press unlock button, in order to:▷ Engage R.

▷ Shift out of P.

Engaging P

Press button P.

Sport program and manual mode

Activating the sport program

Press the selector lever to the left out of selec‐tor lever position D.The sport program of the transmission is acti‐vated.

Activating the M/S manual mode1. Press the selector lever to the left out of

selector lever position D.2. Push the selector lever forward or pull it

backward.Manual mode becomes active and the gear ischanged.The engaged gear is displayed in the instru‐ment cluster, e.g., M1.

Seite 72

Controls Driving

72Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Once maximum engine speed is attained, M/Smanual mode is automatically upshifted asneeded.

Switching to manual mode▷ To shift down: press the selector lever for‐

ward.▷ To shift up: pull the selector lever rear‐

wards.Gears will only be shifted at appropriate engineand road speeds, for example downshifting isnot possible if the engine speed is too high.The selected gear is briefly displayed in the in‐strument cluster, followed by the currently se‐lected gear.

Not M235i: Steptronic Sporttransmission: prevent automaticupshifting in M/S manual modeThe Steptronic Sport transmission does notautomatically upshift in M/S manual modeonce the maximum speed is reached, if one ofthe following conditions is met:▷ DSC deactivated.▷ TRACTION activated.▷ SPORT+ activated.In addition, the kickdown is deactivated.With the respective transmission version, thelowest possible gear can be selected by simul‐taneously operating the kickdown and the leftshift paddle. However, this effect is not pro‐duced via the shift paddles when switchingbriefly from D to manual mode.

M235i: prevent automatic upshiftingin M/S manual modeOnce maximum engine speed is attained, up‐shifting is not automatically performed in M/Smanual mode.In addition, the kickdown is deactivated.The lowest possible gear is selected by simul‐taneously operating the kickdown and the leftshift paddle.

However, this effect is not produced via theshift paddles when switching briefly from D tomanual mode.

Ending the sport program/manualmodePush the selector lever to the right.D is displayed in the instrument cluster.

Shift paddles

The shift paddles on the steering wheel allowyou to shift gears quickly while keeping bothhands on the steering wheel.▷ Shift up: briefly pull right shift paddle.▷ Shift down: briefly pull left shift paddle.▷ With the respective transmission version,

the lowest possible gear can be selectedby pulling and holding the left shift paddle.

Gears will only be shifted at appropriate engineand road speeds, for example downshifting isnot possible if the engine speed is too high.The selected gear is briefly displayed in the in‐strument cluster, followed by the current gear.If the shift paddles on the steering wheel areused to shift gears in automatic mode, thetransmission temporarily switches to manualmode.If the selector lever is still in selector lever po‐sition D with the respective transmission ver‐sion, it is possible to switch back into the auto‐matic mode:▷ Pull and hold right shift paddle.

Or

Seite 73

Driving Controls

73Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

▷ In addition to the briefly pulled right shiftpaddle, briefly pull the left shift paddle.

In the manual mode, after conservative drivingfor a certain amount of time or if there hasbeen no acceleration or shifting of the shiftpaddles within a certain amount of time, thetransmission switches back to automaticmode.

Displays in the instrument clusterThe selector lever position is dis‐played, e.g.: P.

Electronic unlocking of thetransmission lock

General informationElectronically unlock the transmission lock tomaneuver vehicle from the danger area.Unlocking is possible, if the started can spinthe engine.

Engaging selector lever position N1. Depress the brake pedal.2. Press the Start/Stop button. The starter

must audibly start.3. Press and hold the selector lever into posi‐

tion N.A corresponding Check Control messageis displayed.

4. Press the selector lever again into posi‐tion N within approx. 6 seconds.Position N is displayed in the instrumentcluster.

5. Release brake, as soon as the starterstops.

6. Maneuver the vehicle from the danger areaand secure it against moving on its own.

Steptronic Sport transmission:Launch Control

The conceptLaunch Control enables optimum accelerationon surfaces with good traction.

HintsComponent wearDo not use Launch Control too often;

otherwise, this may result in premature wear ofcomponents due to the high stress placed onthe vehicle.◀

Do not use Launch Control during the break-in,refer to page 152, period.To increase vehicle stability, activate DSCagain as soon as possible.An experienced driver may be able to achievebetter acceleration values in DSC OFF mode.

RequirementsLaunch Control is available when the engine iswarmed up, that is, after uninterrupted drivingof at least 6 miles/10 km.To start with Launch Control do not steer thesteering wheel.

Start with launch controlWhile the engine is running:

1. Press button or select Sport+ withthe Driving Dynamics Control.TRACTION is displayed in the instrumentcluster and the indicator lamp for DSC OFFlights up.

2. Engage selector lever position S.3. With the left foot, forcefully press down on

the brake.4. Press and hold down the accelerator pedal

beyond the resistance point at the fullthrottle position.

Seite 74

Controls Driving

74Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

A flag symbol is displayed in the instru‐ment cluster.

5. The starting engine speed adjusts. Within3 seconds, release the brake.

Before using Launch Control, allow the trans‐mission to cool down for approx. 5 minutes.Launch Control adjusts to the surroundingconditions, e.g., wet pavement, when usedagain.

Seite 75

Driving Controls

75Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

DisplaysVehicle features and optionsThis chapter describes all standard, country-specific and optional features offered with theseries. It also describes features that are notnecessarily available in your car, e. g., due to

the selected options or country versions. Thisalso applies to safety-related functions andsystems. The respectively applicable countryprovisions must be observed when using therespective features and systems.

Overview, instrument cluster

1 Speedometer2 Messages, e.g. Check Control3 Tachometer  804 Current fuel consumption

5 Electronic displays  766 Fuel gauge  807 Reset miles  80

Electronic displays▷ Selection lists, refer to page 84.▷ External temperature, refer to page 81.▷ Auto Start/Stop function, refer to page 65.▷ On-board computer, refer to page 85.

▷ Date, refer to page 81.▷ Energy recovery, refer to page 82.▷ Transmission display, refer to page 74.▷ Miles/trip miles, refer to page 80.

Seite 76

Controls Displays

76Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

▷ Messages, e.g. Check Control, refer topage 77.

▷ Navigation display, see User's manual forNavigation, Entertainment and Communi‐cation.

▷ Range, refer to page 81.▷ Status, Driving Dynamics Control, refer to

page 114.▷ Service requirements, refer to page 82.▷ Speed limit detection, refer to page 83.▷ Time, refer to page 81.

Check ControlThe conceptThe Check Control system monitors functionsin the vehicle and notifies you of malfunctionsin the monitored systems.A Check Control message is displayed as acombination of indicator or warning lights andtext messages in the instrument cluster.In addition, an acoustic signal may sound and atext message may appear on the Control Dis‐play.

Indicator/warning lights

General informationThe indicator and warning lights in the instru‐ment cluster can light up in a variety of combi‐nations and colors.Several of the lights are checked for properfunctioning and light up temporarily when theengine is started or the ignition is switched on.

Red lights

Safety belt reminderFlashing or illuminated: safety belt onthe driver or passenger side is notbuckled. The safety belt reminder can

also be activated if objects are placed on thefront passenger seat.Make sure that the safety belts are positionedcorrectly.

Airbag systemAirbag system and belt tensioner aredefective.Have the vehicle checked by the serv‐

ice center immediately.

Parking brake, brake systemFor additional information, refer to Re‐lease parking brake, refer to page 67.

Front-end collision warningIlluminated: advance warning is issued,e.g., when there is the impending dan‐ger of a collision or the distance to the

vehicle ahead is too small.Increase distance.Flashing: acute warning of the imminent dan‐ger of a collision when the vehicle approachesanother vehicle at a relatively high differentialspeed.Intervention by braking or make an evasive ma‐neuver.

Pedestrian warningSymbol in the instrument cluster.

If a collision with a person detected in this wayis imminent, the symbol lights up and a signalsounds.

Seite 77

Displays Controls

77Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Yellow lights

Anti-lock Braking System ABSAvoid abrupt braking if possible. Brak‐ing force boost in some cases defec‐tive. Stop carefully. Take into accountlonger brake travel. Have this checkedby the service center immediately.

DSC Dynamic Stability ControlFlashing: DSC controls the drive andbraking forces. The vehicle is stabi‐lized. Reduce speed and adapt driving

profile to the driving circumstances.Illuminated: DSC failed. Have the systemchecked by the service center.For additional information, refer to DynamicStability Control DSC, refer to page 112.

DSC Dynamic Stability Control isdeactivated or DTC Dynamic TractionControl is activated

Dynamic Stability Control DSC isswitched off or Dynamic Traction Con‐trol DTC is switched on.

For additional information, refer to DynamicStability Control, refer to page 112, and Dy‐namic Traction Control, refer to page 113.

Flat Tire Monitor FTMThe Flat Tire Monitor signals a loss oftire inflation pressure in a tire.Reduce your speed and stop cau‐

tiously. Avoid sudden braking and steering ma‐neuvers.For more information, see Flat Tire Monitor, re‐fer to page 102.

Tire Pressure Monitor TPMIlluminated: the Tire Pressure Monitorsignals a loss of tire inflation pressurein a tire.

Reduce your speed and stop cautiously. Avoidsudden braking and steering maneuvers.Flashing and then continuously illuminated: noflat tire or loss of tire inflation pressure can bedetected.▷ Interference through systems or devices

with the same radio frequency: after leav‐ing the area of the interference, the systemautomatically becomes active again.

▷ TPM could not conclude the reset: performthe reset of the system again.

▷ A wheel without TPM electronics is fitted:have the service center check it if needed.

▷ Malfunction: have the system checked byyour service center.

For more information, see Tire Pressure Moni‐tor, refer to page 98.

Steering systemSteering system in some cases defec‐tive.Have the steering system checked by

the service center.

Engine functionsHave the vehicle checked by the serv‐ice center.For additional information, refer to On-

board Diagnostics socket, refer to page 192.

Lane departure warningSystem is switched on and under cer‐tain circumstances warns if a detectedlane is left without flashing beforehand.

For additional information, refer to Lane depar‐ture warning, refer to page 109.

Seite 78

Controls Displays

78Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Green lights

Turn signalTurn signal on.Unusually rapid flashing of the indicatorlamp indicates that a turn signal bulb

has failed.For additional information, refer to Turn signal,refer to page 67.

Parking lights, headlight controlParking lights or headlights are acti‐vated.

Front fog lightsFront fog lights are activated.For additional information, refer toFront fog lights, refer to page 93.

High-beam AssistantHigh-beam Assistant is switched on.High beams are activated and off auto‐matically as a function of the traffic sit‐

uation.For additional information, refer to High-beamAssistant, refer to page 92.

Cruise controlThe system is switched on. It maintainsthe speed that was set using the con‐trol elements on the steering wheel.

Blue lights

High beamsHigh beams are activated.For additional information, refer to Highbeams, refer to page 68.

General lamps

Check ControlAt least one Check Control message isdisplayed or is stored. The symbol isshown in the display of the instrument

cluster.

Text messagesText messages in combination with a symbolin the instrument cluster explain a Check Con‐trol message and the meaning of the indicatorand warning lights.

Supplementary text messagesAdditional information, such as on the cause ofan error or the required action, can be called upvia Check Control.With urgent messages the added text will beautomatically displayed on the Control Display.

SymbolsWithin the supplementary text, the followingfunctions can be selected independent of thecheck control message.▷ Display additional information about

the Check Control message in theIntegrated Owner's Manual.

▷ "Service request"Contact your service center.

▷ "Roadside Assistance"Contact Roadside Assistance.

Seite 79

Displays Controls

79Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Hiding Check Control messages

Press the onboard computer button on theturn signal lever.

▷ Some Check Control messages are dis‐played continuously and are not cleareduntil the malfunction is eliminated. If sev‐eral malfunctions occur at once, the mes‐sages are displayed consecutively.These messages can be faded for approx.8 seconds. After this time, they are dis‐played again automatically.

▷ Other Check Control messages are fadedautomatically after approx. 20 seconds.They are stored and can be displayedagain later.

Displaying stored Check ControlmessagesOn the Control Display:

1. "Vehicle info"2. "Vehicle status"3. "Check Control"4. Select the text message.

Messages after trip completionSpecial messages displayed while driving aredisplayed again after the ignition is switchedoff.

Fuel gaugeVehicle tilt position may causethe display to vary.Depending on the equipmentversion, the arrow beside thefuel pump symbol shows which

side of the vehicle the fuel filler flap is on.Hints on refueling, refer to page 168.

TachometerAlways avoid engine speeds in the red warningfield. In this range, the fuel supply is inter‐rupted to protect the engine.

Coolant temperatureIf the coolant along with the engine becomestoo hot, a Check Control message is displayed.Check the coolant level, refer to page 190.

Odometer and trip odometerDisplay

▷ Odometer, arrow 1.▷ Trip odometer, arrow 2.

Show/reset kilometersPress the knob.▷ When the ignition is

switched off, the time, theexternal temperature andthe odometer are displayed.

▷ When the ignition is switched on, the tripodometer is reset.

Seite 80

Controls Displays

80Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

External temperatureIf the indicator drops to+37 ℉/+3 ℃ or lower, a signalsounds.A Check Control message isdisplayed.

There is an increased risk of ice on roads.

Ice on roadsEven at temperatures above

+37 ℉/+3 ℃, roads might be icy.Therefore, drive carefully on bridges andshaded roads, e.g., to avoid the increased riskof an accident.◀

TimeThe time is displayed in the in‐strument cluster.Setting the time on the ControlDisplay, refer to page 87.

DateThe date is displayed in the in‐strument cluster.Set the date on the Control Dis‐play, refer to page 88.

RangeDisplay

With a low remaining range:▷ A Check Control message is

displayed briefly.▷ The remaining range is

shown on the computer.▷ With a dynamic driving style - e.g., taking

curves aggressively - engine operationmight vary.

The Check Control message appears continu‐ously below a range of approx. 30 miles/50 km.

Refuel promptlyRefuel no later than at a range of

30 miles/50 km or engine operation might failand damage might occur.◀

Current fuel consumptionInstrument cluster

Displays the current fuel con‐sumption. Check whether youare currently driving in an effi‐cient and environmentally-friendly manner.

Instrument cluster with enhancedfeatures

Displays the current fuel con‐sumption. Check whether youare currently driving in an effi‐cient and environmentally-friendly manner.

Displaying the current fuelconsumptionDepending on your vehicle's optional features,the current fuel consumption can also be dis‐played as bar in the instrument cluster.

1. "Settings"2. "Instrument cluster"3. "Additional indicators"

Seite 81

Displays Controls

81Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Energy recoveryDisplay

The kinetic energy of the vehicleis converted to electrical energywhile coasting. The vehicle bat‐tery is partially charged and fuelconsumption can be reduced.

Service requirementsThe conceptAfter the ignition is turned on the instrumentcluster briefly displays available driving dis‐tance or time to the next scheduled mainte‐nance.Your service specialist can read the currentservice requirements from your remote con‐trol.

DisplayData regarding the service status or legallymandated vehicle inspections are automati‐cally transmitted to your service center beforea service due date.

Detailed information on servicerequirementsMore information on the scope of service re‐quired can be displayed on the Control Dis‐play.On the Control Display:

1. "Vehicle info"2. "Vehicle status"3. "Service required"

Required maintenance procedures and le‐gally mandated inspections are displayed.

4. Select an entry to call up detailed informa‐tion.

Symbols

Sym‐bols

Description

No service is currently required.

The deadline for scheduled mainte‐nance or a legally mandated inspec‐tion is approaching.

The service deadline has alreadypassed.

Entering appointment datesEnter the dates for the required inspections.Make sure that the vehicle's date and time areset correctly.On the Control Display:

1. "Vehicle info"2. "Vehicle status"3. "Service required"4. "§ Vehicle inspection"5. "Date:"6. Adjust the settings.7. Confirm.

The entered date is stored.

Automatic Service RequestData regarding the service status or legallymandated vehicle inspections are automati‐cally transmitted to your service center beforea service due date.You can check when your service center wasnotified.On the Control Display:

1. "Vehicle info"2. "Vehicle status"3. Open "Options".4. "Last Service Request"

Seite 82

Controls Displays

82Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Gear shift indicatorThe conceptThe system recommends the most fuel effi‐cient gear for the current driving situation.Depending on the vehicle's features and coun‐try version of the vehicle, the gear shift indica‐tor is active in the manual mode of the Step‐tronic transmission and with manualtransmission.Suggestions to shift gear up or down are dis‐played in the instrument cluster.

Manual transmission: displaying

Symbol Description

Fuel efficient gear is set.

Shift up to fuel efficient gear.

Shift down to fuel efficient gear.

Shift into neutral.

Steptronic transmission: displays

Example Description

Fuel efficient gear is set.

Shift into fuel efficient gear.

Speed limit detectionThe concept

Speed limit detectionSpeed limit detection uses a symbol in theshape of a traffic sign to display the currentlydetected speed limit. The camera in the area ofthe interior rearview mirror detects traffic signsat the edge of the road as well as variable over‐head sign posts. Traffic signs with extra sym‐bols for wet road conditions, etc. are also de‐tected and compared with the vehicle'sonboard data, such as for the rain sensor, andwill be displayed depending on the situation.The system takes into account the informationstored in the navigation system and also dis‐plays speed limits present on routes withoutsigns.

HintsPersonal judgmentThe system cannot serve as a substitute

for the driver's personal judgment of the trafficsituation.The system assists the driver and does not re‐place the human eye.◀

At a glance

Camera

The camera is found near the interior rearviewmirror.

Seite 83

Displays Controls

83Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Keep the windshield in the area behind the in‐terior rearview mirror clean and clear.

Switching on/offOn the Control Display:

1. "Settings"2. "Instrument cluster"3. "Speed limit information"If speed limit detection is switched on, it canbe displayed on the info display in the instru‐ment cluster via the computer.

DisplayThe following is displayed in the instrumentcluster:

Speed limit detectionCurrent speed limit.

Speed limit detection is notavailable.

System limitsThe system may not be fully functional andmay provide incorrect information in the fol‐lowing situations:▷ In heavy fog, rain or snowfall.▷ When signs are concealed by objects.▷ When driving very close to the vehicle in

front of you.▷ When driving toward bright lights.▷ When the windshield behind the interior

rearview mirror is fogged over, dirty or cov‐ered by a sticker, etc.

▷ In the event of incorrect detection by thecamera.

▷ If the speed limits stored in the navigationsystem are incorrect.

▷ In areas not covered by the navigation sys‐tem.

▷ When roads differ from the navigation,such as due to changes in road routing.

▷ When passing buses or trucks with aspeed sticker.

▷ If the traffic signs are non-conforming.▷ During calibration of the camera immedi‐

ately after vehicle shipment.

Selection lists in theinstrument clusterThe conceptDepending on your vehicle's optional features,the following can be displayed or operated us‐ing the buttons and the thumbwheel on thesteering wheel and the display in the instru‐ment cluster:▷ Current audio source.▷ Redial phone feature.▷ Turn on voice activation system.It also displays programs of the Driving Dy‐namics Control.

Seite 84

Controls Displays

84Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Display

Depending on your vehicle's optional features,the list in the instrument cluster can differ fromthe illustration shown.

Activating a list and adjusting thesetting

On the right side of the steering wheel, turnthe thumbwheel to activate the correspondinglist.Using the thumbwheel, select the desired set‐ting and confirm it by pushing the thumbwheel.

On-board computerCalling up information on the infodisplay

Press the onboard computer button on theturn signal lever.Information is displayed in the info display ofthe instrument cluster.

Information at a glance

Info displayRepeatedly pressing the buttonon the turn signal lever calls upthe following information in theinfo display:▷ Range.

▷ ECO PRO bonus range.▷ Average fuel consumption.▷ Current fuel consumption.▷ Average speed.▷ Date.▷ Speed limit detection.▷ Time of arrival.

When destination guidance is activated inthe navigation system.

▷ Distance to destination.When destination guidance is activated inthe navigation system.

▷ Arrow view of navigation system.

Seite 85

Displays Controls

85Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

When destination guidance is activated inthe navigation system.

Adjusting the info displayDepending on the vehicle equipment version,you can select what information from the com‐puter is to be displayed on the info display ofthe instrument cluster.On the Control Display:

1. "Settings"2. "Instrument cluster"3. Select the desired displays.

Information in detail

RangeDisplays the estimated cruising range availablewith the remaining fuel.It is calculated based on your driving style overthe last 20 miles/30 km.

Average fuel consumptionThe average fuel consumption is calculated forthe period while the engine is running.The average fuel consumption is calculated forthe distance traveled since the last reset by theon-board comupter.

Average speedPeriods in which the vehicle is parked with theengine manually stopped are not included inthe calculation of the average speed.

Resetting average valuesPress and hold the onboard computer buttonon the turn signal lever.

Distance to destinationThe distance remaining to the destination isdisplayed if a destination is entered in the navi‐gation system before the trip is started.

The distance to the destination is adopted au‐tomatically.

Time of arrivalThe estimated time of arrival isdisplayed if a destination is en‐tered in the navigation systembefore the trip is started.

The time must be correctly set.

Speed limit detectionDescription of the speed limit detection, referto page 83, function.

Trip computerThe vehicle features two types of board com‐puters.▷ "Onboard info": the values can be reset as

often as necessary.▷ "Trip computer": the values provide an

overview of the current trip.

Resetting the trip computerOn the Control Display:

1. "Vehicle info"2. "Trip computer"3. "Reset": all values are reset.

"Automatically reset": all values are resetapprox. 4 hours after the vehicle came to astandstill.

Display on the Control DisplayDisplay the computer or trip computer on theControl Display.On the Control Display:

1. "Vehicle info"2. "Onboard info" or "Trip computer"

Seite 86

Controls Displays

86Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Resetting the fuel consumption andspeedOn the Control Display:

1. "Vehicle info"2. "Onboard info"3. "Consumpt." or "Speed"4. "Yes"

Sport displaysThe conceptOn the Control Display, the current values forperformance and torque can be displayed ifthe vehicle is appropriately equipped.

Displaying sport displays on theControl Display1. "Vehicle info"2. "Sport displays"

Speed warningThe conceptDisplays a speed, when reached, should causea warning to be issued.The warning is repeated if the vehicle speeddrops below the set speed once by at least3 mph/5 km/h.

Displaying, setting or changing thespeed warningOn the Control Display:

1. "Settings"2. "Speed"3. "Warning at:"4. Turn the controller until the desired speed

is displayed.5. Press the controller.Speed warning is stored.

Activating/deactivating the speedwarningOn the Control Display:

1. "Settings"2. "Speed"3. "Warning"4. Press the controller.

Setting your current speed as thespeed warningOn the Control Display:

1. "Settings"2. "Speed"3. "Select current speed"4. Press the controller.

The current vehicle speed is stored as thespeed warning.

Settings on the ControlDisplayTime

Setting the time zone1. "Settings"2. "Time/Date"3. "Time zone:"4. Select the desired time zone.The time zone is stored.

Setting the time1. "Settings"2. "Time/Date"3. "Time:"4. Turn the controller until the desired hours

are displayed.5. Press the controller.

Seite 87

Displays Controls

87Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

6. Turn the controller until the desired mi‐nutes are displayed.

7. Press the controller.The time is stored.

Setting the time format1. "Settings"2. "Time/Date"3. "Format:"4. Select the desired format.The time format is stored.

Automatic time settingDepending on your vehicle's optional features,the time, date and, if needed, the time zone areupdated automatically.

1. "Settings"2. "Time/Date"3. "Auto time set"

Date

Setting the date1. "Settings"2. "Time/Date"3. "Date:"4. Turn the controller until the desired day is

displayed.5. Press the controller.6. Make the necessary settings for the month

and year.The date is stored.

Setting the date format1. "Settings"2. "Time/Date"3. "Format:"4. Select the desired format.The date format is stored.

Language

Setting the languageTo set the language on the Control Display:

1. "Settings"2. "Language/Units"3. "Language:"4. Select the desired language.Settings are stored for the profile currently inuse.

Setting the voice dialogVoice dialog for the voice activation system,refer to page 28.

Units of measure

Setting the units of measureTo set the units for fuel consumption, route/distance and temperature:

1. "Settings"2. "Language/Units"3. Select the desired menu item.4. Select the desired unit.Settings are stored for the profile currently inuse.

Brightness

Setting the brightnessTo set the brightness of the Control Display:

1. "Settings"2. "Control display"3. "Brightness"4. Turn the controller until the desired bright‐

ness is set.5. Press the controller.Settings are stored for the profile currently inuse.

Seite 88

Controls Displays

88Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Depending on the light conditions, the bright‐ness settings may not be clearly visible.

Seite 89

Displays Controls

89Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

LightsVehicle features and optionsThis chapter describes all standard, country-specific and optional features offered with theseries. It also describes features that are notnecessarily available in your car, e. g., due tothe selected options or country versions. Thisalso applies to safety-related functions andsystems. The respectively applicable countryprovisions must be observed when using therespective features and systems.

Overview

1 Rear fog lights2 Front fog lights3 Depending on the equipment: automatic

headlight control, Adaptive Light Control,High-beam Assistant, Welcome lights,Daytime running lights

4 Lights off, daytime running lights5 Parking lights, daytime running lights6 Depending on the equipment: low beams,

welcome lights, High-beam Assistant7 Instrument lighting

Parking lights/low beams,headlight controlGeneral informationPosition of switch: , , If the driver door is opened with the ignitionswitched off, the exterior lighting is automati‐cally switched off at these switch settings.

Parking lightsPosition of switch : the vehicle's lightslight up on all sides, e.g., for parking.Do not use the parking lights for extended pe‐riods; otherwise, they might drain the batteryand it would then be impossible to start the en‐gine.When parking, it is preferable to switch on theone-sided roadside parking lights, refer topage 91.

Low beamsPosition of switch with the ignitionswitched on: the low beams light up.

Welcome lightsWhen the vehicle is parked, leave the switch inposition or : parking and interior lightscome on briefly when the vehicle is unlockeddepending on the ambient brightness.

Activating/deactivating1. "Settings"2. "Lighting"3. "Welcome lights"Settings are stored for the profile currently inuse.

Seite 90

Controls Lights

90Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Headlight courtesy delay featureThe low beams stay lit for a short while if theheadlight flasher is switched on after the radio-ready state is switched off.

Setting the duration1. "Settings"2. "Lighting"3. "Pathway lighting:"4. Set length of time.Settings are stored for the profile currently inuse.

Automatic headlight controlPosition of switch : the low beams are acti‐vated and off automatically, e.g., in tunnels, intwilight or if there is precipitation. The indicatorlamp in the instrument cluster lights up.When emerging from a tunnel during the day,the low beams are not switched off immedi‐ately but instead only after approx. 2 minutes.A blue sky with the sun low on the horizon cancause the lights to be switched on.The low beams always stay on when the foglights are activated.

Personal responsibilityThe automatic headlight control cannot

serve as a substitute for your personal judg‐ment in determining when to turn the lights onin response to ambient lighting conditions.E. g. the sensors are unable to detect fog orhazy weather. To avoid safety risks underthese conditions, you should always switch onthe lights manually.◀

Daytime running lightsWith the ignition switched on, the daytime run‐ning lights light up in position , or

. After the ignition is switched off, the park‐ing lights light up in position .

Activating/deactivatingIn some countries, daytime running lights aremandatory, so it may not be possible to deacti‐vate the daytime running lights.

1. "Settings"2. "Lighting"3. "Daytime running lamps"Settings are stored for the profile currently inuse.

Roadside parking lights

The vehicle can be illuminated on one side.

Switching onWith the ignition switched off, press the levereither up or down past the resistance point forapprox. 2 seconds.

Switch offBriefly press the lever to the resistance point inthe opposite direction.

Adaptive Light ControlThe conceptAdaptive Light Control is a variable headlightcontrol system that enables dynamic illumina‐tion of the road surface.Depending on the steering angle and other pa‐rameters, the light from the headlight followsthe course of the road.

Seite 91

Lights Controls

91Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

In tight curves, e.g., on mountainous roads orwhen turning, one of the two front fog lights isswitched on as a turning lamp. As a result theinside of the curve is better lighted.

ActivatingPosition of switch with the ignitionswitched on.To avoid blinding oncoming traffic, the Adap‐tive Light Control does not swivel to the driv‐er's side when the vehicle is at a standstill.The turning lights are automatically switchedon depending on the steering angle or the useof turn signals.When driving in reverse, the turning lights maybe automatically switched on regardless of thesteering angle.

MalfunctionA Check Control message is displayed.Adaptive Light Control is malfunctioning or hasfailed. Have the system checked as soon aspossible.

High-beam AssistantThe conceptWhen the low beams are activated, this systemautomatically switches the high beams on andoff or suppresses the light in the areas thatblind oncoming traffic. The procedure is con‐trolled by a camera on the front of the interiorrearview mirror. The assistant ensures that thehigh beams are activated whenever the trafficsituation allows. The driver can intervene atany time and switch the high beams non andoff as usual.

NotePersonal responsibilityThe High-beam Assistant cannot serve

as a substitute for the driver's personal judg‐ment of when to use the high beams. There‐

fore, manually reel off the high beams in situa‐tions where required to avoid a safety risk.◀

Activating

1. Depending on the equipment, turn the lightswitch into position or .

2. Press button on the turn signal lever, ar‐row.

The indicator lamp in the instrumentcluster lights up.

When the low beams are on, the lights are au‐tomatically brightened or dimmed.The system responds to light from oncomingtraffic and traffic driving ahead of you, and toadequate illumination, e.g., in towns and cities.

The blue indicator lamp in the instru‐ment cluster lights up when the systemswitches on the high beams. Depend‐

ing on the version of the system in the vehicle,the high beams may not switch off for oncom‐ing vehicles, but may only be dimmed in theareas that blind oncoming traffic. In this case,the blue indicator light will stay on.

Seite 92

Controls Lights

92Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Switching the high beams on and offmanually

▷ High beams on, arrow 1.▷ High beams off/headlight flasher, arrow 2.

The High-beam Assistant can be switched offwhen manually adjusting the light. To reacti‐vate the High-beam Assistant, press the but‐ton on the turn signal lever.

System limitsThe system is not fully functional in situationssuch as the following, and driver interventionmay be necessary:▷ In very unfavorable weather conditions,

such as fog or heavy precipitation.▷ When detecting poorly-lit road users such

as pedestrians, cyclists, horseback ridersand wagons; when driving close to train orship traffic; and at animal crossings.

▷ In tight curves, on hilltops or in depres‐sions, in cross traffic or half-obscured on‐coming traffic on freeways.

▷ In poorly-lit towns and cities and in thepresence of highly reflective signs.

▷ At low speeds.▷ When the windshield behind the interior

rearview mirror is fogged over, dirty or cov‐ered with stickers, etc.

Fog lightsFront fog lightsThe low beams must be switched on.

Press button. The green indicatorlamp lights up.

If the automatic headlight control, refer topage 91, is activated, the low beams will comeon automatically when you switch on the frontfog lights.When the high beams or headlight flasher areactivated, the front fog lights are not switchedon.

Instrument lightingAdjusting

The parking lights or low beamsmust be switched on to adjustthe brightness.Adjust the brightness with thethumbwheel.

Interior lightsGeneral informationThe interior lights, footwell lights, access lightsand courtesy lights are controlled automati‐cally.Thumb wheel for the instrument lighting con‐trols brightness of some of these features.

Seite 93

Lights Controls

93Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Overview

1 Interior lights2 Reading lamp

Switching the interior lights on and offPress button.

To reel off permanently: press the button forapprox. 3 seconds.Switch back on: press button.

Reading lightsPress button.

Reading lights are located at the front and rearnext to the interior lights.

Ambient lightDepending on your optional features lightingcan be adjusted for some lights in the interior.

Selecting color schemeOn the Control Display:

1. "Settings"2. "Lighting"3. "Ambient:"4. Select desired setting.With a color scheme selected and welcomelights activated they illuminate in the line'scolor when vehicle is unlocked.

Setting the brightnessThe brightness of the ambient light can be ad‐justed via the thumbwheel for the instrumentlighting or on the Control Display.On the Control Display:

1. "Settings"2. "Lighting"3. "Brightness:"4. Adjust the brightness.

Seite 94

Controls Lights

94Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

SafetyVehicle features and optionsThis chapter describes all standard, country-specific and optional features offered with theseries. It also describes features that are notnecessarily available in your car, e. g., due to

the selected options or country versions. Thisalso applies to safety-related functions andsystems. The respectively applicable countryprovisions must be observed when using therespective features and systems.

Airbags

1 Front airbag, driver2 Front airbag, front passenger3 Head airbag

4 Side airbag5 Knee airbags

Front airbagsFront airbags help protect the driver and frontpassenger by responding to frontal impacts inwhich safety belts alone would not provide ad‐equate restraint.

Side airbagsIn a lateral impact, the side airbag supports theside of the body in the chest and lap area.

Head airbagsIn a lateral impact, the head airbag supportsthe head.

Seite 95

Safety Controls

95Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Ejection MitigationThe head airbag system is designed as anejection mitigation countermeasure to reducethe likelihood of ejections of vehicle occupantsthrough side windows during rollovers or sideimpact events.

Knee airbagThe knee airbag supports the legs in a frontalimpact.

Protective actionAirbags are not triggered in every impact situa‐tion, e.g., in less severe accidents or rear-endcollisions.

Information on how to ensure the optimalprotective effect of the airbags

▷ Keep at a distance from the airbags.▷ Always grasp the steering wheel on the

steering wheel rim, holding your hands atthe 3 o'clock and 9 o'clock positions, tokeep the risk of injury to your hands orarms as low as possible when the airbag istriggered.

▷ There should be no person, animals, or ob‐jects between an airbag and a person.

▷ Do not use the cover of the front airbag onthe front passenger side as a storage area.

▷ Dashboard and windshield on the frontpassenger side must stay clear - do not at‐tach adhesive labels or coverings and donot attach brackets or cables, e. g., for GPSdevices or' mobile phones.

▷ Make sure that the front passenger is sit‐ting correctly, i.e., keeps his or her feet andlegs in the footwell; otherwise, leg injuriesmight occur when front airbag is activated.

▷ Do not place slip covers, seat cushions orother objects on the front passenger seatthat are not approved specifically for seatswith integrated side airbags.

▷ Do not hang pieces of clothing, such asjackets, over the backrests.

▷ Make sure that occupants keep their headsaway from the side airbag and do not restagainst the head airbag; otherwise, injuriesmight occur when airbag is activated.

▷ Do not remove the airbag system.▷ Do not remove the steering wheel.▷ Do not apply adhesive materials to the air‐

bag cover panels, do not cover them ormodify them in any way.

▷ Never modify either the individual compo‐nents or the wiring in the airbag system.This also applies to steering wheel covers,the dashboard, the seats, the roof pillarsand the sides of the roofliner.◀

Even when you follow all instructions veryclosely, injury from contact with the airbagscannot be ruled out in certain situations.The ignition and inflation noise may lead toshort-term and, in most cases, temporaryhearing impairment in sensitive individuals.

Malfunction, deactivation and after de‐ploying the airbags

Do not touch the individual components imme‐diately after the system has been triggered;otherwise, you may risk burns.Only have the airbags checked, repaired or dis‐mantled and the airbag generator scrapped bythe service center or an authorized repair shopfor handling explosives.Non-professional attempts to service the sys‐tem could lead to failure in an emergency orunintentional activation of the airbag - bothmay lead to injury.◀

Warnings and information on the airbags arealso found on the sun visors.

Functional readiness of the airbagsystem

When the ignition is reel on, the warn‐ing lamp in the instrument cluster lightsup briefly and thereby indicates the op‐

Seite 96

Controls Safety

96Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

erational readiness of the entire airbag systemand the belt tensioner.

Airbag system malfunctioning▷ Warning lamp does not come on when the

ignition is turned on.▷ The warning lamp lights up continuously.

In case of a malfunction have airbag sys‐tem checked immediately.

In case of a malfunction have airbag systemchecked immediately; otherwise, there is a riskthat the system does not function as expectedin case of a severe accident.◀

Automatic deactivation of the front-seat passenger airbagsThe system reads if the front passenger seat isoccupied by measuring the human body's re‐sistance.Front, knee and side airbag on the front pas‐senger's side are either activated or deacti‐vated.

Leave feet in the footwellMake sure that the front passenger

keeps his or her feet in the footwell; otherwise,proper functioning of the front passenger air‐bag might not be assured.◀

Child restraint fixing system in the frontpassenger seat

Before transporting a child on the front pas‐senger seat, refer to the safety notes and in‐structions for children on the front passengerseat, see Children.◀

Malfunction of the automaticdeactivation systemWhen transporting older children and adults,the front-seat passenger airbags may be deac‐tivated in certain sitting positions. In this case,the indicator lamp for the front-seat passengerairbags lights up.

In this case, change the sitting position so thatthe front-seat passenger airbags are activatedand the indicator lamp goes out.If it is not possible to activate the airbags, havethe person sit in the rear.To enable correct recognition of the occupiedseat cushion▷ Do not attach covers, cushions, ball mats

or other items to the front passenger seatunless they are specifically recommendedby your vehicle's manufacturer.

▷ Do not place any electronic devices on thepassenger seat if a child restraint system isto be installed on it.

▷ Do not place objects under the seat thatcould press against the seat from below.

▷ No moisture in or on the seat.

Indicator lamp for the front-seatpassenger airbags

The indicator lamp for the front-seat passen‐ger airbags indicates the operating state of thefront-seat passenger airbags.The lamp indicates whether the airbags are ei‐ther activated or deactivated.

▷ The indicator lamp lights upwhen a child is properlyseated in a child restraint fix‐ing system or when the seatis empty. The airbags on thefront passenger side are notactivated.

▷ The indicator lamp does not light up when,e.g., a correctly seated person of sufficient

Seite 97

Safety Controls

97Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

size is detected on the seat. The airbagson the front passenger side are activated.

Detected child seatsThe system generally detects children seatedin a child seat, particularly in child seats re‐quired by NHTSA when the vehicle was manu‐factured. After installing a child seat, makesure that the indicator lamp for the front-seatpassenger airbags lights up. This indicatesthat the child seat has been detected and thefront-seat passenger airbags are not activated.

Strength of the driver's and front-seatpassenger airbagThe explosive power that activates driver's/front passenger's airbags very much dependson the positions of the driver's/front passeng‐er's seat.With a respective message appearing on Con‐trol Display calibrate the front seats to keepthe accuracy of this function over the long-term.

Calibrating the front seatsA corresponding message appears on theControl Display.

1. Press the reel and move the respectiveseat all the way forward.

2. Press the reel forward again. The seat stillmoves forward slightly.

3. Readjust the seat to the desired position.The calibration procedure is completed whenthe message on the Control Display disap‐pears.If the message continues to be displayed, re‐peat the calibration.If the message does not disappear after a re‐peat calibration, have the system checked assoon as possible.

Unobstructed area of movementEnsure that the area of movement of the

seats is unobstructed to avoid personal injuryor damage to objects.◀

Tire Pressure Monitor TPMThe conceptThe system monitors tire inflation pressure inthe four mounted tires. The system warns youif there is a significant loss of pressure in oneor more tires. For this purpose, sensors in thetire valves measure the tire inflation pressureand tire temperature.

HintsTire damage due to external factorsSudden tire damage caused by external

circumstances cannot be recognized in ad‐vance.◀

With use of the system observe further infor‐mation found under Tire inflation pressure, re‐fer to page 172.

Functional requirementsThe system must have been reset with thecorrect tire inflation pressure; otherwise, relia‐ble signaling of tire inflation pressure loss isnot assured.Reset the system after each adjustment of thetire inflation pressure and after every tire orwheel change.Always use wheels with TPM electronics toensure that the system will operate properly.

Status displayThe current status of the Tire Pressure Moni‐tor TPM can be displayed on the Control Dis‐play, e.g., whether or not the TPM is active.

1. "Vehicle info"2. "Vehicle status"

Seite 98

Controls Safety

98Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

3. "Tire Pressure Monitor (TPM)"The status is displayed.

Status control displayTire and system status are indicated by thecolor of the wheels and a text message on theControl Display.

All wheels greenSystem is active and will issue a warning rela‐tive to the tire inflation pressures stored duringthe last reset.

One wheel is yellowA flat tire or major drop in inflation pressure inthe indicated tire.

All wheels are yellowA flat tire or major drop in inflation pressure inseveral tires.

Wheels, grayThe system cannot detect a flat tire due to amalfunction.

Status informationThe status control display additionally showsthe current tire inflation pressures. It shows theactual values read; they may vary dependingon driving style or weather conditions.

Carry out resetReset the system after each adjustment of thetire inflation pressure and after every tire orwheel change.On the Control Display and on the vehicle:

1. "Vehicle info"2. "Vehicle status"3. "Perform reset"4. Start the engine - do not drive off.

5. Reset tire inflation pressure:"Performreset".

6. Drive away.The tires are shown in gray and the status isdisplayed.After driving faster than 19 mph/30 km/h for ashort period, the set tire inflation pressures areaccepted as reference values. The reset iscompleted automatically while driving.The progress of the reset is displayed.After a successfully completed Reset, thewheels on the Control Display are shown ingreen and "Tire Pressure Monitor (TPM)active" is displayed.You may interrupt this trip at any time. Whenyou continue the reset resumes automatically.

Low tire pressure messageThe yellow warning lamp lights up. ACheck Control message is displayed.▷ There is a flat tire or a major loss in

tire inflation pressure.▷ No reset was performed for the system.

The system therefore issues a warningbased on the tire inflation pressures beforethe last reset.

1. Reduce your speed and stop cautiously.Avoid sudden braking and steering maneu‐vers.

2. Check whether the vehicle is fitted withregular tires or run-flat tires.Run-flat tires, refer to page 180, are la‐beled with a circular symbol containing theletters RSC marked on the tire's sidewall.

Do not continue driving without run-flattires

Do not continue driving if the vehicle is notequipped with run-flat tires; continued drivingmay result in serious accidents.◀

A low tire inflation pressure might turn on DSCDynamic Stability Control.

Seite 99

Safety Controls

99Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Actions in the event of a flat tire

Normal tires1. Identify the damaged tire.

Do this by checking the air pressure in allfour tires.If the tire inflation pressure in all four tiresis correct, the Tire Pressure Monitor maynot have been initialized. In this case, initi‐alize the system.If an identification is not possible, pleasecontact the service center.

2. Rectify the flat tire on the damaged wheel.Use of tire sealant, e.g., the Mobility System,may damage the TPM wheel electronics. Inthis case, have the electronics checked at thenext opportunity and have them replaced ifneeded.

Run-flat tires

Maximum speedYou may continue driving with a damaged tireat speeds up to 50 mph/80 km/h.

Continued driving with a flat tireIf continuing to drive with a damaged tire:

1. Avoid sudden braking and steering maneu‐vers.

2. Do not exceed a speed of 50 mph/80 km/h.3. Check the air pressure in all four tires at

the next opportunity.If the tire inflation pressure in all four tiresis shown to be correct, it is possible thatthe Tire Pressure Monitor did not performa reset. In that case, carry out a reset.

Possible driving distance with complete loss oftire inflation pressure:The possible driving distance after a loss of tireinflation pressure depends on cargo load, driv‐ing style and road conditions.

A vehicle with an average load has a possibledriving range of approx. 50 miles/80 km.A vehicle with a damaged tire reacts differ‐ently, e.g., it has reduced lane stability duringbraking, a longer braking distance and differentself-steering properties. Adjust your drivingstyle accordingly. Avoid abrupt steering ma‐neuvers or driving over obstacles, e.g., curbs,potholes, etc.Because the possible driving distance de‐pends on how the vehicle is used during thetrip, the actual distance may be shorter or lon‐ger depending on the driving speed, road con‐ditions, external temperature, cargo load, etc.

Continued driving with a flat tireDrive moderately and do not exceed a

speed of 50 mph/80 km/h.Your car handles differently when you lose tireinflation pressure, e.g., your lane stability is re‐duced when braking, braking distances arelonger and the self-steering properties willchange.◀

Final tire failureVibrations or loud noises while driving

can indicate the final failure of a tire. Reducespeed and stop; otherwise, pieces of the tirecould come loose and cause an accident. Donot continue driving and contact your servicecenter.◀

Required tire inflation pressure checkmessageA Check Control message is displayed in thefollowing situations▷ The system has detected a wheel change,

but no reset was done.▷ Inflation was not carried out according to

specifications.▷ The tire inflation pressure has fallen below

the level of the last confirmation.In this case:

Seite 100

Controls Safety

100Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

▷ Check the tire pressure and correct asneeded.

▷ Carry out a reset of the system after a tirechange.

System limitsThe system does not function properly if a re‐set has not been carried out, e.g., a flat tire isreported though tire inflation pressures arecorrect.The tire inflation pressure depends on thetire's temperature. Driving or exposure to thesun will increase the tire's temperature, thusincreasing the tire inflation pressure. The tireinflation pressure is reduced when the tiretemperature falls again. These circumstancesmay cause a warning when temperatures fallvery sharply.

MalfunctionThe yellow warning lamp flashes andthen lights up continuously. A CheckControl message is displayed. No flat

tire or loss of tire inflation pressure can be de‐tected.

Display in the following situations:▷ A wheel without TPM electronics is fitted:

have the service center check it if needed.▷ Malfunction: have the system checked by

your service center.▷ TPM was unable to complete the reset.

Reset the system again.▷ Interference through systems or devices

with the same radio frequency: after leav‐ing the area of the interference, the systemautomatically becomes active again.

Declaration according to NHTSA/FMVSS 138 Tire Pressure MonitoringSystemEach tire, including the spare (if provided)should be checked monthly when cold and in‐flated to the inflation pressure recommended

by the vehicle manufacturer on the vehicleplacard or tire inflation pressure label. (If yourvehicle has tires of a different size than the sizeindicated on the vehicle placard or tire inflationpressure label, you should determine theproper tire inflation pressure for those tires.)As an added safety feature, your vehicle hasbeen equipped with a tire pressure monitoringsystem (TPMS) that illuminates a low tire pres‐sure telltale when one or more of your tires issignificantly under-inflated. Accordingly, whenthe low tire pressure telltale illuminates, youshould stop and check your tires as soon aspossible, and inflate them to the proper pres‐sure. Driving on a significantly under-inflatedtire causes the tire to overheat and can lead totire failure. Under-inflation also reduces fuel ef‐ficiency and tire tread life, and may affect thevehicle's handling and stopping ability. Pleasenote that the TPMS is not a substitute forproper tire maintenance, and it is the driver'sresponsibility to maintain correct tire pressure,even if under-inflation has not reached thelevel to trigger illumination of the TPMS lowtire pressure telltale. Your vehicle has alsobeen equipped with a TPMS malfunction indi‐cator to indicate when the system is not oper‐ating properly. The TPMS malfunction indica‐tor is combined with the low tire pressuretelltale. When the system detects a malfunc‐tion, the telltale will flash for approximately oneminute and then remain continuously illumi‐nated. This sequence will continue upon sub‐sequent vehicle start-ups as long as the mal‐function exists. When the malfunction indicatoris illuminated, the system may not be able todetect or signal low tire pressure as intended.TPMS malfunctions may occur for a variety ofreasons, including the installation of replace‐ment or alternate tires or wheels on the vehiclethat prevent the TPMS from functioning prop‐erly. Always check the TPMS malfunction tell‐tale after replacing one or more tires or wheelson your vehicle to ensure that the replacementor alternate tires and wheels allow the TPMSto continue to function properly.

Seite 101

Safety Controls

101Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

FTM Flat Tire MonitorThe conceptThe system detects tire inflation pressure losson the basis of rotation speed differences be‐tween the individual wheels while driving.In the event of a tire inflation pressure loss, thediameter and therefore the rotational speed ofthe corresponding wheel changes. This will bedetected and reported as a flat tire.The system does not measure the actual infla‐tion pressure in the tires.

Functional requirementsThe system must have been initialized whenthe tire inflation pressure was correct; other‐wise, reliable flagging of a flat tire is not as‐sured. Initialize the system after each correc‐tion of the tire inflation pressure and afterevery tire or wheel change.

Status displayThe current status of the Flat Tire Monitor canbe displayed on the Control Display, e.g.,whether or not the FTM is active.

1. "Vehicle info"2. "Vehicle status"3. "Flat Tire Monitor (FTM)"The status is displayed.

InitializationWhen initializing the once set inflation tirepressures serve as reference values in order todetect a flat tire. Initialization is started by con‐firming the tire inflation pressures.Do not initialize the system when driving withsnow chains.On the Control Display:

1. "Vehicle info"2. "Vehicle status"3. "Perform reset"

4. Start the engine - do not drive off.5. Start the initialization with "Perform reset".6. Drive away.The initialization is completed while driving,which can be interrupted at any time.The initialization automatically continues whendriving resumes.

Indication of a flat tireThe yellow warning lamp lights up. ACheck Control message is displayed.There is a flat tire or a major loss in tire

inflation pressure.

1. Reduce your speed and stop cautiously.Avoid sudden braking and steering maneu‐vers.

2. Check whether the vehicle is fitted withregular tires or run-flat tires.Run-flat tires, refer to page 180, are la‐beled with a circular symbol containing theletters RSC marked on the tire's sidewall.

Do not continue driving without run-flattires

Do not continue driving if the vehicle is notequipped with run-flat tires; continued drivingmay result in serious accidents.◀

When a flat tire is indicated, DSC Dynamic Sta‐bility Control is switched on if needed.

System limitsSudden tire damageSudden serious tire damage caused by

external circumstances cannot be recognizedin advance.◀

A natural, even tire inflation pressure loss in allfour tires will not be recognized. Therefore,check the tire inflation pressure regularly.The system could be delayed or malfunction inthe following situations:▷ When the system has not been initialized.

Seite 102

Controls Safety

102Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

▷ When driving on a snowy or slippery roadsurface.

▷ Sporty driving style: spinning tractionwheels, high lateral acceleration (drifting).

▷ When driving with snow chains.

Actions in the event of a flat tire

Normal tires1. Identify the damaged tire.

Do this by checking the air pressure in allfour tires.If the tire inflation pressure in all four tiresis correct, the Flat Tire Monitor may nothave been initialized. In this case, initializethe system.If an identification is not possible, pleasecontact the service center.

2. Rectify the flat tire on the damaged wheel.

Run-flat tires

Maximum speedYou may continue driving with a damaged tireat speeds up to 50 mph/80 km/h.

Continued driving with a flat tireIf continuing to drive with a damaged tire:

1. Avoid sudden braking and steering maneu‐vers.

2. Do not exceed a speed of 50 mph/80 km/h.3. Check the air pressure in all four tires at

the next opportunity.If the tire inflation pressure in all four tiresis correct, the Flat Tire Monitor may nothave been initialized. In this case, initializethe system.

Possible driving distance with complete loss oftire inflation pressure:The possible driving distance after a loss of tireinflation pressure depends on cargo load, driv‐ing style and road conditions.

A vehicle with an average load has a possibledriving range of approx. 50 miles/80 km.A vehicle with a damaged tire reacts differ‐ently, e.g., it has reduced lane stability duringbraking, a longer braking distance and differentself-steering properties. Adjust your drivingstyle accordingly. Avoid abrupt steering ma‐neuvers or driving over obstacles, e.g., curbs,potholes, etc.Because the possible driving distance de‐pends on how the vehicle is used during thetrip, the actual distance may be shorter or lon‐ger depending on the driving speed, road con‐ditions, external temperature, cargo load, etc.

Continued driving with a flat tireDrive moderately and do not exceed a

speed of 50 mph/80 km/h.Your car handles differently when you lose tireinflation pressure, e.g., your lane stability is re‐duced when braking, braking distances arelonger and the self-steering properties willchange.◀

Final tire failureVibrations or loud noises while driving

can indicate the final failure of a tire. Reducespeed and stop; otherwise, pieces of the tirecould come loose and cause an accident. Donot continue driving and contact your servicecenter.◀

Intelligent SafetyThe conceptIntelligent Safety enables central operation ofthe driver assistance system.Depending on how the vehicle is equipped, In‐telligent Safety consists of one or more sys‐tems that can help prevent a imminent colli‐sion. These systems are active automaticallyevery time the engine is started using theStart/Stop button:

Seite 103

Safety Controls

103Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

▷ Front-end collision warning with City Brak‐ing function, refer to page 104.

▷ Pedestrian warning, refer to page 107.

HintsPersonal responsibilityThe system does not serve as a substi‐

tute for the driver's personal judgment of thetraffic situation.Be aware of the traffic situation and the vehi‐cle's surroundings at all times, otherwise acci‐dents are still possible despite all warnings.◀

Adapting your speed and driving styleThe displays and warnings of the system

do not relieve the driver of the responsibility toadapt his or her driving speed and style to thetraffic conditions.◀

Be alertDue to system limitations, warnings may

be not issued at all, or may be issued late orimproperly. Therefore, always be alert andready to intervene; otherwise, there is the riskof an accident.◀

Tow-starting and towingFor tow-starting or towing, switch off the

Intelligent Safety systems; otherwise malfunc‐tions of the individual braking systems mightlead to accidents.◀

At a glance

Button in the vehicle

Intelligent Safety button

Camera

The camera is found near the interior rearviewmirror.Keep the windshield in the area behind the in‐terior rearview mirror clean and clear.

Switching on/offThe Intelligent Safety systems are automati‐cally active after every departure.

Press button: the systems are turnedoff. The LED goes out.

Press button: the systems are turned on. TheLED lights up.

Settings can be made on the Control Display.

Front-end collision warningwith City Braking functionThe conceptThe ystem can help prevent accidents. If anaccident cannot be prevented, the system willhelp reduce the collision speed.The system sounds a warning before an immi‐nent collision and actuates brakes independ‐ently if needed.The automatic braking intervention is donewith limited force and duration.A camera in the area of the rearview mirrorcontrols the system.

Seite 104

Controls Safety

104Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

The front-end collision warning is availableeven if cruise control has been deactivated.With the vehicle approaching another vehicleintentionally the collision warning is delayedavoiding false alarm.

General informationThe system warns at two levels of an imminentdanger of collision at speeds from approx.3 mph/5 km/h. Time of warnings may vary withthe current driving situation.Appropriate braking kicks in at speeds of up to35 mph/60 km/h.

Detection range

It responds to objects if they are detected bythe system.

HintsPersonal responsibilityThe system does not serve as a substi‐

tute for the driver's personal judgment of thetraffic situation.Be aware of the traffic situation and the vehi‐cle's surroundings at all times, otherwise acci‐dents are still possible despite all warnings.◀

Adapting your speed and driving styleThe displays and warnings of the system

do not relieve the driver of the responsibility toadapt his or her driving speed and style to thetraffic conditions.◀

Be alertDue to system limitations, warnings may

be not issued at all, or may be issued late orimproperly. Therefore, always be alert andready to intervene; otherwise, there is the riskof an accident.◀

Tow-starting and towingFor tow-starting or towing, switch off the

Intelligent Safety systems; otherwise malfunc‐tions of the individual braking systems mightlead to accidents.◀

At a glance

Button in the vehicle

Intelligent Safety button

Camera

The camera is found near the interior rearviewmirror.Keep the windshield in the area behind the in‐terior rearview mirror clean and clear.

Seite 105

Safety Controls

105Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Switching on/off

Switching on automaticallyThe system is automatically active after everydriving-off.

Switch offPress button: the system is switchedoff. The LED goes out.

Re-press button: the system is switched on.The LED lights up.

Setting the warning timeThe warning time can be set via iDrive.

1. "Settings"2. "Frontal Coll. Warning"3. Activate the desired time on the Control

Display.The selected time is stored for the profile cur‐rently in use.

Warning with braking function

DisplayIf a collision with a recognized vehicle is immi‐nent a warning symbol appears in the instru‐ment cluster and in the Head-Up Display.

Symbol Measure

The vehicle lights up red: prewarn‐ing.Brake and increase distance.

The vehicle flashes red and anacoustic signal sounds: acute warn‐ing.You are requested to intervene bybraking or make an evasive maneu‐ver.

PrewarningThis warning is issued, e.g., when there is theimpending danger of a collision or the distanceto the vehicle ahead is too small.The driver must intervene actively when thereis a prewarning.

Acute warning with braking functionWarning of the imminent danger of a collisionwhen the vehicle approaches another object ata relatively high differential speed.The driver must intervene actively when thereis an acute warning. If necessary, the driver isassisted by a minor automatic braking inter‐vention in a possible risk of collision.Acute warnings can also be triggered withoutprevious prewarning.

Braking interventionThe warning prompts the driver himself/herselfto react. During a warning, the maximum brak‐ing force is used. Premise for the brake boos‐ter is sufficiently quick and hard stepping onthe brake pedal. The system can assist withsome braking intervention if there is risk of acollision. At low speeds vehicles may thuscome to a complete stop.Manual transmission: During a braking inter‐vention up to a complete stop, the engine maybe shut down.The braking intervention is executed only ifDSC Dynamic Stability Control is switched onand Dynamic Traction Control DTC is acti‐vated.The braking intervention can be interrupted bystepping on the accelerator pedal or by ac‐tively moving the steering wheel.Object detection can be restricted. Limitationsof the detection range and functional restric‐tions are to be considered.

Seite 106

Controls Safety

106Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

System limits

Detection rangeThe system's detection potential is limited.Thus a warning might not be issued or be is‐sued late.E. g. the following situations may not be de‐tected:▷ Slow moving vehicles when you approach

them at high speed.▷ Vehicles that suddenly swerve in front of

you, or sharply decelerating vehicles.▷ Vehicles with an unusual rear appearance.▷ Two-wheeled vehicles ahead of you.

Functional limitationsThe system may not be fully functional in thefollowing situations:▷ In heavy fog, rain, sprayed water or snow‐

fall.▷ In tight curves.▷ If the driving stability control systems are

limited or deactivated, e.g., DSC OFF.▷ If the field of view of the camera in the mir‐

ror is dirty or obscured.▷ Up to 10 seconds after the start of the en‐

gine, via the Start/Stop knob.▷ During calibration of the camera immedi‐

ately after vehicle shipment.▷ If there is constant blinding effects be‐

cause of oncoming light, e. g., from the sunlow in the sky.

Warning sensitivityThe more sensitive the warning settings are,e.g. the warning time, the more warnings aredisplayed. However, there may also be an ex‐cess of false warnings.

Pedestrian warning with citybraking functionThe conceptThe ystem can help prevent accidents with pe‐destrians.The system issues a warning in the city drivingspeed area if there is imminent danger of a col‐lision with pedestrians and includes a brakingfunction.The camera in the area of the rearview mirrorcontrols the system.

General informationIn daylight the system warns of possible colli‐sions with pedestrians at speeds from about6 mph/10 km/h to about 35 mph/60 km/hshortly before a collision the system supportsyou with a braking intervention.Under those circumstances it reacts to peoplewho are within the detection range of the sys‐tem.

Detection range

The detection area in front of the vehicle is div‐ided into two areas.▷ Central area, arrow 1, directly in front of the

vehicle.▷ Expanded area, arrow 2, to the right and

left.A collision is imminent if pedestrians are lo‐cated within the central area. A warning is is‐sued about pedestrians who are located within

Seite 107

Safety Controls

107Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

the extended area only if they are moving inthe direction of the central area.

HintsPersonal responsibilityThe system does not serve as a substi‐

tute for the driver's personal judgment of thetraffic situation.Be aware of the traffic situation and the vehi‐cle's surroundings at all times, otherwise acci‐dents are still possible despite all warnings.◀

Adapting your speed and driving styleThe displays and warnings of the system

do not relieve the driver of the responsibility toadapt his or her driving speed and style to thetraffic conditions.◀

Be alertDue to system limitations, warnings may

be not issued at all, or may be issued late orimproperly. Therefore, always be alert andready to intervene; otherwise, there is the riskof an accident.◀

Tow-starting and towingFor tow-starting or towing, switch off the

Intelligent Safety systems; otherwise malfunc‐tions of the individual braking systems mightlead to accidents.◀

At a glance

Button in the vehicle

Intelligent Safety button

Camera

The camera is found near the interior rearviewmirror.Keep the windshield in the area behind the in‐terior rearview mirror clean and clear.

Switching on/off

Switching on automaticallyThe system is automatically active after everydriving-off.

Switch offPress button: the systems are turnedoff. The LED goes out.

Press button: the systems are turned on. TheLED lights up.

Warning with braking function

DisplayIf a collision with a person detected in this wayis imminent, a warning symbol appears on theinstrument cluster and in the Head-up Display.

The red symbol is displayed and a sig‐nal sounds.

Intervene immediately by braking or make anevasive maneuver.

Seite 108

Controls Safety

108Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Braking interventionThe warning prompts the driver himself/herselfto react. During a warning, the maximum brak‐ing force is used. Premise for the brake boos‐ter is sufficiently quick and hard stepping onthe brake pedal. The system can assist withsome braking intervention if there is risk of acollision. At low speeds vehicles may thuscome to a complete stop.Manual transmission: During a braking inter‐vention up to a complete stop, the engine maybe shut down.The braking intervention is executed only ifDSC Dynamic Stability Control is switched onand Dynamic Traction Control DTC is acti‐vated.The braking intervention can be interrupted bystepping on the accelerator pedal or by ac‐tively moving the steering wheel.Object detection can be restricted. Limitationsof the detection range and functional restric‐tions are to be considered.

System limits

Detection rangeThe detection potential of the camera is lim‐ited.Thus a warning might not be issued or be is‐sued late.E. g. the following situations may not be de‐tected:▷ Partially covered pedestrians.▷ Pedestrians that are not detected as such

because of the viewing angle or contour.▷ Pedestrians outside of the detection range.▷ Pedestrians having a body size less than

32 in/80 cm.

Functional limitationsThe system may not be fully functional or maynot be available in the following situations:

▷ In heavy fog, rain, sprayed water or snow‐fall.

▷ In tight curves.▷ If the driving stability control systems are

deactivated, e.g. DSC OFF.▷ If the camera viewing field or the front

windshield are dirty or covered.▷ Up to 10 seconds after the start of the en‐

gine, via the Start/Stop knob.▷ During calibration of the camera immedi‐

ately after vehicle shipment.▷ If there is constant blinding effects be‐

cause of oncoming light, e. g., from the sunlow in the sky.

▷ When it is dark outside.

Lane departure warningThe conceptStarting at a specific speed, this system alertsyou when the vehicle on streets with lanemarkings is about to leave the lane. Thisspeed, depending on the country version, isbetween 35 mph/55 km/h and45 mph/70 km/h.When switching on the system below thisspeed, a message is displayed in the instru‐ment cluster.The steering wheel begins vibrating gently inthe event of warnings. The time of the warningmay vary depending on the current driving sit‐uation.The system does not provide a warning if theturn signal is set before leaving the lane.

HintsPersonal responsibilityThe system cannot serve as a substitute

for the driver's personal judgment of thecourse of the road and the traffic situation.

Seite 109

Safety Controls

109Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

In the event of a warning, do not jerk the steer‐ing wheel, as you may lose control of the vehi‐cle.◀

At a glance

Button in the vehicle

Lane departure warning

Camera

The camera is found near the interior rearviewmirror.Keep the windshield in the area behind the in‐terior rearview mirror clean and clear.

Switching on/offPress button.

▷ On: the LED lights up.▷ Off: the LED goes out.Settings are stored for the profile currently inuse.

Display in the instrument cluster▷ Lines: system is activated.▷ Arrows: at least one lane marking

was detected and warnings can beissued.

Issued warningIf you leave the lane and if a lane marking hasbeen detected, the steering wheel begins vi‐brating.If the turn signal is set before changing thelane, a warning is not issued.

End of warningThe warning ends:▷ Automatically after approx. 3 seconds.▷ When returning to your own lane.▷ When braking hard.▷ When using the turn signal.

System limitsThe system may not be fully functional in thefollowing situations:▷ In heavy fog, rain or snowfall.▷ In the event of missing, worn, poorly visi‐

ble, merging, diverging, or multiple lanemarkings such as in construction areas.

▷ When lane markings are covered in snow,ice, dirt or water.

▷ In tight curves or on narrow lanes.▷ When the lane markings are covered by

objects.▷ When driving very close to the vehicle in

front of you.▷ When driving toward bright lights.▷ When the windshield in front of the interior

rearview mirror is fogged over, dirty or cov‐ered with stickers, etc.

▷ During calibration of the camera immedi‐ately after vehicle shipment.

Seite 110

Controls Safety

110Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Brake force displayThe concept

▷ During normal brake application, the bot‐tom brake lights light up.

▷ During heavy brake application, the topbrake lights light up in addition.

Attentiveness assistantThe conceptThe system can detect increasing lack of alert‐ness or fatigue of the driver during long, mo‐notonous journeys, e.g., on highways. In thissituation, it is recommended that the drivertakes a break.

NotePersonal responsibilityThe system cannot act as a substitute for

the personal assessment of one's physicalstate and may not detect an increasing lack ofalertness or fatigue or may not detect it cor‐rectly. Therefore, make sure that the driver isrested and alert; otherwise, risks may be de‐tected too late and an accident be caused as aresult.◀

FunctionThe system is activated each time the engineis started and cannot be switched off.

After travel has begun, the system is trainedabout the driver, so that increasing lack ofalertness or fatigue can be detected.This procedure takes the following criteria intoaccount:▷ Personal driving style, e.g., steering behav‐

ior.▷ Driving conditions, e.g., length of trip.Starting at approximately 43 mph/70 km/h, thesystem is active and can display a recommen‐dation to take a break.

Break recommendationIf the driver becomes increasingly less alert orfatigued, a message is displayed in the ControlDisplay with the recommendation to take abreak.A recommendation to take a break is displayedonly once during an uninterrupted trip.After a break, another recommendation to takea break cannot be displayed until after approxi‐mately 45 minutes.

System limitsThe function may be limited in the followingsituations, for instance, and will either outputan incorrect warning or no warning at all:▷ When the clock is set incorrectly.▷ When the vehicle speed is mainly below

about 43 mph/70 km/h.▷ With a sporty driving style, such as during

rapid acceleration or when cornering fast.▷ In active driving situations, such as when

changing lanes frequently.▷ When the road surface is poor.▷ In the event of strong side winds.

Seite 111

Safety Controls

111Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Driving stability control systemsVehicle features and optionsThis chapter describes all standard, country-specific and optional features offered with theseries. It also describes features that are notnecessarily available in your car, e. g., due tothe selected options or country versions. Thisalso applies to safety-related functions andsystems. The respectively applicable countryprovisions must be observed when using therespective features and systems.

Antilock Brake System ABSABS prevents locking of the wheels duringbraking.The vehicle contains its steering power evenduring full brake applications, thus increasingactive safety.ABS is operational every time you start the en‐gine.

Brake assistantWhen you apply the brakes rapidly, this systemautomatically produces the greatest possiblebraking force boost. It reduces the braking dis‐tance to a minimum during emergency stop.This system utilizes all of the benefits providedby ABS.Do not reduce the pressure on the brake pedalfor the duration of the emergency stop.

DSC Dynamic StabilityControlThe conceptDSC prevents traction loss in the powerwheels when driving off and accelerating.

DSC also recognizes unstable vehicle condi‐tions such as fishtailing or nose-diving. Withinthe physical limits DSC helps to keep the vehi‐cle on a steady course by reducing enginespeed and by applying brakes to the individualwheels.

NoteAdjust your driving style to the situationAn appropriate driving style is always the

responsibility of the driver.The laws of physics cannot be repealed, noteven with DSC.Therefore, do not reduce the additional safetymargin by driving in a risky manner.◀

Do not deactivate DSC when driving withroof load

Do not deactivate Dynamic Stability ControlDSC when driving with roof load, e.g. roof-mounted luggage rack.Otherwise, driving safety is not given in driv‐ing-critical situation due to the elevated centerof gravity.◀

Overview

Button in the vehicle

DSC OFF button

Seite 112

Controls Driving stability control systems

112Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Indicator/warning lightsThe indicator lamp flashes: DSC con‐trols the drive and braking forces.The indicator lamp lights up: DSC has

failed.

Deactivating DSC: DSC OFFWhen DSC is deactivated, driving stability isreduced during acceleration and when drivingin curves.To increase vehicle stability, activate DSCagain as soon as possible.

Deactivating DSCPress and hold this button but not lon‐ger than approx. 10 seconds, until the

indicator lamp for DSC OFF lights up in the in‐strument cluster and displays DSC OFF.The DSC system is switched off.The steering and, depending on the equip‐ment, suspension are tuned for sporty driving.

Activating DSCPress button.DSC OFF and the DSC OFF indicator

lamp go out.

Indicator/warning lightsWhen DSC is deactivated, DSC OFF is dis‐played in the instrument cluster.

The indicator lamp lights up: DSC isdeactivated.

DTC Dynamic TractionControlThe conceptThe DTC system is a version of the DSC whereforward momentum is optimized.

The system ensures maximum headway onspecial road conditions or loose road surfaces,e.g., unplowed snowy roads, but with some‐what limited driving stability.Activating the Dynamic Traction Control DTCprovides maximum traction. Driving stability islimited during acceleration and when driving incurves.Therefore drive with appropriate caution.You may find it useful to briefly activate DTCunder the following special circumstances:▷ When driving in slush or on uncleared,

snow-covered roads.▷ When freeing vehicle from deep snow or

driving off from loose grounds.▷ When driving with snow chains.

Deactivating/activating DTC DynamicTraction Control

Activating DTCPress button.TRACTION is displayed in the instru‐

ment cluster and the indicator lamp for DSCOFF lights up.

Deactivating DTCPress button again.TRACTION and the DSC OFF indica‐

tor lamp go out.

xDrivexDrive is the all-wheel-drive system of your ve‐hicle. Concerted action by the xDrive and DSCfurther optimize traction and driving dynamics.The xDrive all-wheel-drive system variably dis‐tributes the drive forces to the front and rearaxles as demanded by the driving situation androad surface.

Seite 113

Driving stability control systems Controls

113Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Dynamic Damping ControlThe conceptThis system reduces undesirable vehicle mo‐tion when using a dynamic driving style or trav‐eling on uneven road surfaces.The system enhances driving dynamics andcomfort fitting road surface and driving style.

ProgramsThe system offers several different programs.Select the programs via the Driving DynamicsControl, refer to page 114.

SPORTConsistently sporty control of the shock ab‐sorbers for greater driving agility.

SPORT+Consistently sporty control of the shock ab‐sorbers for greater driving agility when drivingwith limited driving stabilization.

COMFORT/ECO PROBalanced control of the vehicle.

Variable sport steeringThe variable sport steering increases thesteering angle of the front wheels at largesteering wheel angles, e.g., in tight curves orwhen parking. Steering becomes more direct.It also varies the force required to turn thewheels in accordance with the vehicle speed.This results in a sporty steering response. Inaddition, it becomes easier to steer duringparking and maneuvering.

ServotronicThe conceptThe Servotronic varies the steering force re‐quired to turn the wheels in accordance withthe vehicle speed. At low speeds, the steeringforce is strongly supported, i. e. during steer‐ing, low force is required. As the speed in‐creases, the assistance of the steering force isreduced.Furthermore, the steering force adapts accord‐ing to the driving program, so that a direct,sporty feel and/or comfortable steering is con‐veyed.

Driving Dynamics ControlThe conceptThe Driving Dynamics Control helps to fine-tune the vehicle's settings and features. Vari‐ous programs can be selected for this purpose.The Driving Dynamics Control and the DSCOFF buttons can each be used to activate aprogram.

Overview

Button in the vehicle

Seite 114

Controls Driving stability control systems

114Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Operating the programs

Press button Program

DSC OFFTRACTION

SPORT+SPORTCOMFORTECO PRO

Automatic program changeThe system may automatically switch to COM‐FORT in the following situations:▷ Failure of Dynamic Damping Control.▷ Failure of DSC Dynamic Stability Control.▷ The vehicle has a flat tire.▷ When activating cruise control in TRAC‐

TION or DSC OFF mode.

DSC OFFWhen DSC OFF, refer to page 113, is active,driving stability is limited during accelerationand when driving in curves.

TRACTIONWhen TRACTION is active, the vehicle hasmaximum traction on loose road surfaces. DTCDynamic Traction Control, refer to page 113, isactivated. Driving stability is limited during ac‐celeration and when driving in curves.

SPORT+Sporty driving with optimized suspension andadapted engine control with limited driving sta‐bilization.Dynamic Traction Control is switched on.The driver handles several of the stabilizationtasks.

Activating SPORT+Press button repeatedly until SPORT+appears in the instrument cluster and

the DSC OFF indicator lamp lights up.

Automatic program changeWhen activating cruise control, the programautomatically switches to SPORT mode.

Indicator/warning lightsSPORT+ is displayed in the instrument cluster.

The DSC OFF indicator lamp lights up:Dynamic Traction Control is activated.

SPORTDepending on the equipment, consistentlysporty tuning of the suspension, steering, andengine control for greater driving agility withmaximum driving stabilization.The program can be configured to individualspecifications. The configuration is stored forthe profile currently in use.

Activating SPORTPress button repeatedly until SPORTis displayed in the instrument cluster.

Configuring SPORTWhen the display is activated on the ControlDisplay, refer to page 116, the SPORT drivingmode can be set to individual specifications.▷ Activating SPORT.▷ "Configure SPORT"▷ Configuring the SPORT driving mode.SPORT can also be configured before it is acti‐vated:

1. "Settings"2. "Driving mode"3. "Configure SPORT"4. Configure driving mode.

Seite 115

Driving stability control systems Controls

115Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

This configuration is retrieved when theSPORT driving mode is activated.

COMFORTFor a balanced tuning with maximum drivingstabilization.

Activating COMFORTPress button repeatedly until COM‐FORT is displayed in the instrument

cluster.

In certain situations, the system automaticallychanges to the NORMAL program, automaticprogram change, refer to page 115.

ECO PROECO PRO, refer to page 159, provides consis‐tent tuning to minimize fuel consumption formaximum range with maximum driving stabili‐zation.Comfort functions and the engine controllerare adjusted.The program can be configured to individualspecifications.

Activating ECO PROPress button repeatedly until ECOPRO is displayed in the instrument

cluster.

Configuring ECO PRO1. Activate ECO PRO.2. "Configure ECO PRO"Make the desired settings.

Configuring driving programSettings can be made for the following drivingprograms in Driving mode:▷ SPORT, refer to page 115.▷ ECO PRO, refer to page 160.

Displays

Program selectionPressing the button displays alist of the selectable programs.Depending on your vehicle's op‐tional features, the list in the in‐strument cluster can differ from

the illustration shown.

Selected programThe instrument cluster displaysthe selected program.

Display on the Control DisplayProgram changes can be displayed on theControl Display.

1. "Settings"2. "Control display"3. "Driving mode info"

Drive-off assistantThis system supports driving off on inclines.The parking brake is not required.

1. Hold the vehicle in place with the footbrake.

2. Release the foot brake and drive off with‐out delay.

After the foot brake is released, the vehicle isheld in place for approx. 2 seconds.For vehicles with respective equipment ver‐sions, the possible holding duration amountsto 2 minutes.Depending on the vehicle load or when a traileris used, the vehicle may roll back slightly.

Seite 116

Controls Driving stability control systems

116Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Driving off without delayAfter releasing the foot brake, start driv‐

ing without delay, since the drive-off assistantwill not hold the vehicle in place for more thanapprox. 2 seconds and the vehicle will begin toroll back.◀

Seite 117

Driving stability control systems Controls

117Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Driving comfortVehicle features and optionsThis chapter describes all standard, country-specific and optional features offered with theseries. It also describes features that are notnecessarily available in your car, e. g., due tothe selected options or country versions. Thisalso applies to safety-related functions andsystems. The respectively applicable countryprovisions must be observed when using therespective features and systems.

Cruise controlThe conceptThe system maintains a preset speed via thebuttons on the steering wheel. The systembrakes on downhill gradients if engine brakingis insufficient.

General informationDepending on the driving settings, the featuresof the cruise control can change in certainareas.

HintsUnfavorable conditionsDo not use the system if unfavorable

conditions make it impossible to drive at a con‐stant speed, e.g.:▷ On winding roads.▷ In heavy traffic.▷ On slippery roads, in fog, snow or rain, or

on a loose road surface.Otherwise, you could lose control of the vehi‐cle and cause an accident.◀

Overview

Buttons on the steering wheel

Press button Function

System on/off, interrupt

Store speed

Resume speed

rocker switch: change, hold,store speed

Controls

Switching onPress button on the steering wheel.

The marking in the speedometer is set to thecurrent speed.Cruise control can be used.

Switch offDeactivated or interrupted systemWith deactivated or interrupted system

use your brakes, steering and moves as usualto avoid the chance of an accident.◀

Press button.

▷ If active: press twice.▷ If interrupted: press once.The displays go out. The stored desired speedis deleted.

Seite 118

Controls Driving comfort

118Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

InterruptingWhen active, press the button.

The system is automatically interrupted if:▷ The brakes are applied.▷ The clutch pedal is depressed for a few

seconds or released while a gear is not en‐gaged.

▷ The gear engaged is too high for the cur‐rent speed.

▷ Selector lever position D is disengaged.▷ DTC Dynamic Traction Control is activated

or DSC is deactivated.▷ DSC is actively controlling stability.▷ When SPORT+ is activated with Driving

Dynamics Control.

Maintaining, storing, and changing thespeed

HintsAdjusting the desired speedModify desired speed to road conditions

and be ready to brake at all times; otherwise,there is the risk of an accident.◀

Maintaining/storing the speedPress button.Or:

Press the rocker switch while the system is in‐terrupted.

When the system is switched on, the currentspeed is maintained and stored as the desiredspeed.This is displayed, refer to page 120, in thespeedometer and briefly in the instrumentcluster.When cruise control is maintained or stored,DSC Dynamic Stability Control will be turnedon if needed.

Changing the speedPress the rocker switch up or down repeatedlyuntil the desired speed is set.If active, the displayed speed is stored and thevehicle reaches the stored speed when theroad is clear.▷ Each time the rocker switch is pressed to

the point of resistance, the desired speedincreases or decreases by approx.1 mph/1 km/h.

▷ Each time the rocker switch is pressedpast the point of resistance, the desiredspeed increases or decreases by a maxi‐mum of 5 mph/10 km/h.The maximum speed that can be set de‐pends on the vehicle.

▷ Pressing the rocker switch to the resist‐ance point and holding it accelerates or de‐celerates the vehicle without requiringpressure on the accelerator pedal.After the rocker switch is released, the ve‐hicle maintains its final speed. Pressing theswitch beyond the resistance point causesthe vehicle to accelerate more rapidly.

Resuming the desired speedPress button.

The stored speed is reached and maintained.

Seite 119

Driving comfort Controls

119Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Displays in the instrument cluster

Indicator lampDepending on how the vehicle is equip‐ped, the indicator lamp in the instru‐ment cluster indicates whether the sys‐

tem is switched on.

Desired speed▷ The marking lights up green:

the system is active.▷ The marking lights up or‐

ange: the system has beeninterrupted.

▷ The marking does not light up: the systemis switched off.

Brief status displaySelected desired speed.

If --- appears briefly on the display for CheckControl messages, it is possible that the sys‐tem requirements are currently not ready foroperations.

PDC Park Distance ControlThe conceptPDC is a support when parking. When youslowly approach an object in the rear - or alsoin the front of the vehicle if the feature is availa‐ble - then the object is reported through:▷ Signal tones.▷ Visual display.

General informationUltrasound sensors in the bumpers measurethe distances from objects.

The maneuvering range, depending on the ob‐stacle and environmental conditions, is approx.6 ft/2 m.An acoustic warning is first given:▷ By the front sensors and the two rear cor‐

ner sensors at approx. 24 in/60 cm.▷ By the rear middle sensors at approx.

5 ft/1.50 m.To ensure full functionality:▷ Do not cover sensors, e.g., with stickers,

bicycle racks.▷ Keep the sensors clean and free of ice.▷ When using high-pressure washers, do not

spray the sensors for long periods andmaintain a distance of at least 12 in/30 cm.

HintsPersonal responsibilityEven an active system does not relieve

the driver from personal responsibility whiledriving.Technically the system has its limits, it cannotindependently react to all traffic situations.Monitor your driving, be on the alert, observethe vehicle surroundings and other traffic andreact when needed - risk of accident.◀

Avoid driving fast with PDCAvoid approaching an object too fast.

Avoid driving off fast while PDC is not yet ac‐tive.For technical reasons, the system may other‐wise be too late in issuing a warning.◀

Seite 120

Controls Driving comfort

120Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Overview

With front PDC: button in vehicle

PDC Park Distance Control

Switching on/off

Switching on automaticallyPDC switches on automatically in the followingsituations:▷ If selector lever position R is engaged

when the engine is running.The rearview camera also switches on.

▷ If equipped with parking assistant: whenobstacles are detected behind or in front ofthe vehicle by PDC and the speed is slowerthan approx. 2.5 mph/4 km/h.

You may turn off automatic activation:

1. "Settings"2. "Parking"3. Select setting.

Settings are stored for the profile currentlyin use.

Automatic deactivation during forwardtravelThe system switches off when a certain drivingdistance or speed is exceeded.Switch the system back on if needed.

With front PDC: switching on/offmanually

Press button.

▷ On: the LED lights up.▷ Off: the LED goes out.The rearview camera image is displayed whenthe reverse gear is engaged by pressing thebutton.

Display

Signal tonesWhen approaching an object, an intermittentsound indicates the position of the object. E. g.if an object is detected to the left rear of thevehicle, a signal tone sounds from the left rearspeaker.The shorter the distance to the object, theshorter the intervals.If the distance to a detected object is less thanapprox. 10 in/25 cm, a continuous tone issounded.With front PDC: if objects are located both infront of and behind the vehicle, an alternatingcontinuous signal is sounded.The signal tone is switched off, when selectorlever position P is engaged on vehicles withSteptronic transmission.

VolumeThe volume of the PDC signal tone can be ad‐justed similar to the sound and volume set‐tings of the radio.Settings are stored for the profile currently inuse.

Visual warningThe approach of the vehicle to an object canbe shown on the Control Display. Objects thatare farther away are already displayed on theControl Display before a signal sounds.

Seite 121

Driving comfort Controls

121Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

A display appears as soon as Park DistanceControl (PDC) is activated.The range of the sensors is represented in thecolors green, yellow and red.When the image of the rearview camera is dis‐played, the reel can be made to PDC:

"Rear view camera"

System limits

Limits of ultrasonic measurementUltrasonic measuring might not function underthe following circumstances:▷ For small children and animals.▷ For persons with certain clothing, e.g.

coats.▷ With external interference of the ultra‐

sound, e.g. from passing vehicles or loudmachines.

▷ When sensors are dirty, iced over, dam‐aged or out of position.

▷ Under certain weather conditions such ashigh relative humidity, rain, snowfall, ex‐treme heat or strong wind.

▷ With tow bars and trailer couplings of othervehicles.

▷ With thin or wedge-shaped objects.▷ With moving objects.▷ With elevated, protruding objects such as

ledges or cargo.▷ With objects with corners and sharp edges.▷ With objects with a fine surface structure

such as fences.▷ For objects with porous surfaces.Low objects already displayed, e.g., curbs, canmove into the blind area of the sensors beforeor after a continuous tone sounds.

False warningsPDC may issue a warning under the followingconditions even though there is no obstaclewithin the detection range:▷ In heavy rain.▷ When sensors are very dirty or covered

with ice.▷ When sensors are covered in snow.▷ On rough road surfaces.▷ On uneven surfaces, such as speed

bumps.▷ In large buildings with right angles and

smooth walls, e.g., in underground ga‐rages.

▷ In automatic car washes.▷ Through heavy pollution.▷ Due to other ultrasound sources, e.g.,

sweeping machines, high pressure steamcleaners or neon lights.The malfunction is signaled by a continu‐ous tone alternating between the front andrear speakers. As soon as the malfunctiondue to other ultrasound sources is no lon‐ger present, the system is again fully func‐tional.

MalfunctionA Check Control message is displayed.The range of the sensors is shown as a shadedarea on the Control Display.PDC has failed. Have the system checked.To ensure full functionality:▷ Keep the sensors clean and free of ice.▷ dimmedDo not put any stickers on sen‐

sors.▷ When using high-pressure washers, do not

spray the sensors for long periods andmaintain a distance of at least 12 in/30 cm.

Seite 122

Controls Driving comfort

122Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Rearview cameraThe conceptThe rearview camera provides assistance inparking and maneuvering backwards. The areabehind the vehicle is shown on the ControlDisplay.

HintsCheck the traffic situation as wellCheck the traffic situation around the ve‐

hicle with your own eyes. Otherwise, an acci‐dent could result from road users or objectsthat are not lidtured by the camera.◀

At a glance

Button in the vehicle

Rearview camera

Camera

The camera lens is located in the handle of thetail gate. The image quality may be impaired bydirt.

Clean the camera lens, refer to page 211.

Switching on/off

Switching on automaticallyWith the engine running, engage lever in posi‐tion P R.

Automatic deactivation during forwardtravelThe system switches off when a certain drivingdistance or speed is exceeded.Switch the system back on if needed.

Switching on/off manuallyPress button.

▷ On: the LED lights up.▷ Off: the LED goes out.The PDC is shown on the Control Display.The rearview camera image is displayed whenthe reverse gear is engaged by pressing thebutton.

Switching the view via iDriveWith PDC activated:

"Rear view camera"The rearview camera image is displayed.

Display on the Control Display

Functional requirement▷ The rearview camera is switched on.▷ The trunk lid is fully closed.

Activating assistance functionsMore than one assistance function can be ac‐tive at the same time.▷ Parking aid lines

"Parking aid lines"Lanes and turning radius are indicated.

Seite 123

Driving comfort Controls

123Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

▷ Obstacle marking "Obstacle marking"

Spatially-shaped markings are displayed.

Pathway lines

▷ Pathway lines can be superimposed on theimage of the rearview camera.

▷ They help you to estimate how muchspace is needed when parking and maneu‐vering on level pavement.

▷ They are dependent on the current steer‐ing angle and are continuously adjusted tothe steering wheel movements.

Turning circle lines

▷ Turning circle lines can only be superim‐posed on the rearview camera image to‐gether with pathway lines.

▷ They show the course of the smallest pos‐sible turning radius on a level road.

▷ Only one turning radius line is displayed af‐ter the steering wheel is turned past a cer‐tain angle.

Obstacle marking

Obstacle markings can be faded into the imageof the rearview camera.Their colored margins match the markings ofthe PDC. This simplifies estimation of the dis‐tance to the object shown.

Parking using pathway and turningradius lines1. Position the vehicle so that the turning ra‐

dius lines lead to within the limits of theparking space.

2. Turn the steering wheel to the point wherethe pathway line covers the correspondingturning radius line.

Seite 124

Controls Driving comfort

124Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Display settings

BrightnessWith the rearview camera switched on:

1. Select the symbol.2. Turn the controller until the desired setting

is reached, and press the controller.

ContrastWith the rearview camera switched on:

1. Select the symbol.2. Turn the controller until the desired setting

is reached, and press the controller.

System limits

Detection of objectsVery low obstacles as well as high, protrudingobjects such as ledges may not be detected bythe system.Assistance functions also take into accountdata of the PDC.Follow instructions in the PDC chapter, refer topage 120.The objects displayed on the Control Displayunder certain circumstances are closer thanthey appear. Do not estimate the distance fromthe objects on the display.

Parking assistantThe concept

The system supports parking in the followingsituations:▷ When parking parallel to the road.▷ When reverse parking diagonally to the

road.Ultrasound sensors measure parking spaceson both sides of the vehicle.The parking assistant calculates the best pos‐sible parking line and takes control of steeringduring the parking procedure.When parking, also take note of the visual andacoustic information and instructions issuedby the PDC, the parking assistant and the rear‐view camera and react accordingly.A component of the parking assistant is thePDC Park Distance Control, refer to page 120.

HintsPersonal responsibilityEven an active system does not relieve

the driver from personal responsibility whiledriving.Technically the system has its limits, it cannotindependently react to all traffic situations.Monitor your driving, be on the alert, observethe vehicle surroundings and other traffic andreact when needed - risk of accident.◀

Changes to the parking spaceChanges to the parking space after it was

measured are not taken into account by thesystem.Therefore, always be alert and ready to inter‐vene; otherwise, there is the risk of an acci‐dent.◀

Transporting cargoCargo that extends beyond the perimeter

of the vehicle is not taken into account by thesystem during the parking procedure.Therefore, always be alert and ready to inter‐vene; otherwise, there is the risk of an acci‐dent.◀

Seite 125

Driving comfort Controls

125Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

CurbsThe parking assistant may steer the vehi‐

cle over or onto curb if need be.Therefore, always be alert and ready to inter‐vene; otherwise, the wheels, tires, or the vehi‐cle may become damaged.◀

An engine that has been switched off by theAuto Start Stop function is restarted automati‐cally when the parking assistant is activated.

Requirements

For measuring parking spaces▷ Maximum speed while driving forward ap‐

prox. 22 mph/35 km/h.▷ Maximum distance to row of parked vehi‐

cles: 5 ft/1.5 m.

Suitable parking spaceGeneral information:▷ Gap behind an object that has a min. length

of 1.7 ft/0.5 m.▷ Gap between two objects with a minimum

length of approx. 1.7 ft/0.5 m.Parallel parking to the road:▷ Min. length of gap between two objects:

your vehicle's length plus approx.2.6 ft/0.8 m.

▷ Minimum depth: approx. 5 ft/1.5 m.Diagonal parking:▷ Width of gap between two objects: your

vehicle's width plus approx. 2.3 ft/0.7 m upto maximum 16 ft/5 m.

▷ Minimum depth: your vehicle's length.The depth of diagonal parking spaces mustbe estimated by the driver. Dur to technicallimitations, the system can approximatethe depth of diagonal parking spaces only.

Regarding the parking procedure▷ Doors and trunk lid closed.

▷ Parking brake released.▷ When parking in parking spaces on the

driver's side, the corresponding turn signalmust be set where applicable.

Overview

Button in the vehicle

Parking assistant

Ultrasound sensors

The four ultrasound sensors for measuringparking spaces are located in the front and rearon the side of the vehicle.To ensure full functionality:▷ Keep the sensors clean and free of ice.▷ When using high-pressure washers, do not

spray the sensors for long periods andmaintain a distance of at least 12 in/30 cm.

▷ Do not put stickers over sensors.

Seite 126

Controls Driving comfort

126Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Switching on/off

Switching on with the buttonPress button.The LED lights up.

The current status of the parking space searchis indicated on the Control Display.

Parking assistant is activated automatically.

Switching on with the reverse gearShift into reverse.The current status of the parking space searchis indicated on the Control Display.To activate: "Parking Assistant"

Switch offThe system can be deactivated as follows:▷ Press button.

▷ Switch off the ignition.

Display on the Control Display

System activated/deactivated

Symbol Meaning

Gray: the system is not available.White: the system is available butnot activated.

The system is activated.

System status

▷ Symbol P, refer to Arrow, on the vehicle il‐lustrated. Parking assistant is activated andsearch for parking space active.

▷ Control Display shows suitable parkingspaces at the edge of the road next to thevehicle symbol. When the parking assistantis active, suitable parking spaces are high‐lighted.

▷ If a diagonal or parallel parking space isclearly detected, the system automaticallyadjusts the suitable parking method. In thecase of parking spaces suitable for paralleland diagonal parking, a selection menu isdisplayed. In this case, the desired parkingmethod must be selected manually.

▷ The parking procedure is ac‐tive. Steering control hasbeen taken over by system.

▷ Parking space search is always activewhenever the vehicle is moving forwardslow and straight, even if the system is de‐activated. When the system is deactivated,the displays on the Control Display areshown in gray.

Parking using the parking assistantCheck the traffic situation as wellLouds noises outside and inside the ve‐

hicle can drown out the parking assistant's andPDC's signals.Check the traffic situation around the vehiclewith your own eyes; otherwise, there is a dan‐ger of an accident.◀

1. Switch on the parking assistant and acti‐vate it if needed.The status of the parking space search isindicated on the Control Display.

2. Follow the instructions on the Control Dis‐play.The best possible parking position willcome after gear change on the stationary

Seite 127

Driving comfort Controls

127Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

vehicle - wait for the automatic steeringwheel move.The end of the parking procedure is indi‐cated on the Control Display.

3. Adjust the parking position yourself ifneeded.

Interrupting manuallyThe parking assistant can be interrupted at anytime:▷ "Parking Assistant" Select the symbol

on the Control Display.▷ Press button.

Interrupting automaticallyThe system is interrupted automatically in thefollowing situations:▷ If the driver grasps the steering wheel or if

he takes over steering.▷ If a gear is selected that does not match

the instruction on the Control Display.▷ If the vehicle speed exceeds approx.

6 mph/10 km/h.▷ Possible on snow-covered or slippery road

surfaces.▷ When there are obstacles that are hard to

overcome, such as curbs.▷ When there are obstacles that suddenly

arise.▷ If the Park Distance Control PDC displays

clearances that are too small.▷ If a maximum number of parking attempts

or the time taken for parking is exceeded.▷ If DSC is being deactivated.▷ When switching to another function on the

Control Display.A Check Control message is displayed.

ResumeAn interrupted parking procedure can be con‐tinued if needed.

Follow the instructions on the Control Displayto do this.

System limits

No parking assistanceThe parking assistant does not offer assis‐tance in the following situations:▷ In tight curves.▷ When DSC is deactivated.

Functional limitationsThe system may not be fully functional in thefollowing situations:▷ On bumpy road surfaces such as gravel

roads.▷ On slippery ground.▷ On steep uphill or downhill grades.▷ With accumulations of leaves/snow in the

parking space.

Limits of ultrasonic measurementUltrasonic measuring might not function underthe following circumstances:▷ For small children and animals.▷ For persons with certain clothing, e.g.

coats.▷ With external interference of the ultra‐

sound, e.g. from passing vehicles or loudmachines.

▷ When sensors are dirty, iced over, dam‐aged or out of position.

▷ Under certain weather conditions such ashigh relative humidity, rain, snowfall, ex‐treme heat or strong wind.

▷ With tow bars and trailer couplings of othervehicles.

▷ With thin or wedge-shaped objects.▷ With moving objects.▷ With elevated, protruding objects such as

ledges or cargo.

Seite 128

Controls Driving comfort

128Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

▷ With objects with corners and sharp edges.▷ With objects with a fine surface structure

such as fences.▷ For objects with porous surfaces.Low objects already displayed, e.g., curbs, canmove into the blind area of the sensors beforeor after a continuous tone sounds.The parking assistant may identify parkingspaces that are not suitable for parking.

MalfunctionA Check Control message is displayed.The parking assistant failed. Have the systemchecked.

Seite 129

Driving comfort Controls

129Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Climate controlVehicle features and optionsThis chapter describes all standard, country-specific and optional features offered with theseries. It also describes features that are notnecessarily available in your car, e. g., due to

the selected options or country versions. Thisalso applies to safety-related functions andsystems. The respectively applicable countryprovisions must be observed when using therespective features and systems.

Automatic climate control

1 Seat heating, left  512 Vent settings3 Rear window defroster4 Air flow5 AUTO program

6 Temperature7 Seat heating, right  518 Cooling function9 Recirculated-air mode10 Interior temperature sensor

HintsSufficient ventilationWhen remaining in the vehicle for an ex‐

tended period of time, ensure sufficient exter‐nal ventilation. Do not continuously use recir‐culated-air mode; otherwise the air quality in

the interior continuously deteriorates and win‐dow condensation increases.◀

Seite 130

Controls Climate control

130Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Climate control functions in detail

Manual air distributionTurn the wheel to select the de‐sired program or the desired in‐termediate setting.

▷ Windows.▷ Upper body region.▷ Windows, upper body region, and foot‐

well.▷ Footwell.

Defrosts windows and removescondensationDirect the air distribution toward windows, in‐crease the air flow and temperature, and, ifneeded, use the cooling function.

Rear window defrosterPress button.The rear window defroster switches

off automatically after a certain period of time.

Air flow, manualPress the left or right side of the but‐ton: decrease or increase air flow.

The air flow from the air conditioner may be re‐duced automatically to save battery power.

AUTO programPress button.Air flow, air distribution and tempera‐

ture are controlled automatically.

Depending on the selected temperature andoutside influences, the air is directed to thewindshield, side windows, upper body, andinto the footwell.

The cooling function, refer to page 131, isswitched on automatically with the AUTO pro‐gram.

TemperatureTurn the ring to set the desiredtemperature.

The automatic climate control reaches thistemperature as quickly as possible, if neededby increasing the cooling or heating output,and then keeps it constant.Do not rapidly switch between different tem‐perature settings. Otherwise, the automatic cli‐mate control will not have sufficient time to ad‐just the set temperature.

Cooling functionThe car's interior can only be cooled with theengine running.

Press button.The air will be cooled and dehumidi‐

fied and, depending on the temperature set‐ting, warmed again.

Depending on the weather, the windshield andside windows may fog up briefly when the en‐gine is started.The cooling function is switched on automati‐cally with the AUTO program.When using the automatic climate control,condensation water, refer to page 154, devel‐ops that exits underneath the vehicle.

Recirculated-air modeYou may respond to unpleasant odors or pollu‐tants in the immediate environment by tempo‐rarily suspending the supply of outside air. Thesystem then recirculates the air currentlywithin the vehicle.

Seite 131

Climate control Controls

131Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Press button repeatedly to select anoperating mode:

▷ LED off: outside air flows in continuously.▷ LED on, recirculated-air mode: the supply

of outside air into the vehicle is perma‐nently blocked.

Recirculated air mode switches off automati‐cally at low external temperatures after a cer‐tain amount of time in order to avoid windowfogging.If the windows fog over, switch off recircu‐lated-air mode and increase the air flow, ifneeded.

Sufficient ventilationWhen remaining in the vehicle for an ex‐

tended period of time, ensure sufficient exter‐nal ventilation. Do not continuously use recir‐culated-air mode; otherwise the air quality inthe interior continuously deteriorates and win‐dow condensation increases.◀

Switching the system on/off

Switch offPress the left button for the minimumspeed.

Switching onPress any button except▷ Rear window defroster.▷ Seat heating.

MicrofilterIn external and recirculated air mode the mi‐crofilter filters dust and pollen from the air.This filter should be replaced during scheduledmaintenance, refer to page 191, of your vehi‐cle.

Automatic climate control with enhanced features

1 Seat heating, left  51 2 Temperature, left

Seite 132

Controls Climate control

132Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

3 AUTO program4 Display5 Maximum cooling6 Temperature, right7 Seat heating, right  518 Cooling function9 Automatic recirculated-air control/recircu‐

lated-air mode

10 Air distribution, right11 Air flow, AUTO intensity12 Air distribution, left13 Rear window defroster14 Interior temperature sensor — always keep

clear15 Defrosts windows and removes condensa‐

tion

HintsSufficient ventilationWhen remaining in the vehicle for an ex‐

tended period of time, ensure sufficient exter‐nal ventilation. Do not continuously use recir‐culated-air mode; otherwise the air quality inthe interior continuously deteriorates and win‐dow condensation increases.◀

Climate control functions in detail

TemperatureTurn the ring to set the desiredtemperature.

The automatic climate control reaches thistemperature as quickly as possible, if neededby increasing the cooling or heating output,and then keeps it constant.Do not rapidly switch between different tem‐perature settings. Otherwise, the automatic cli‐mate control will not have sufficient time to ad‐just the set temperature.

AUTO programPress button.Air flow, air distribution and tempera‐

ture are controlled automatically.

Depending on the selected temperature,AUTO intensity program and outside influen‐ces, the air is directed to the windshield, sidewindows, upper body, and into the footwell.The cooling function, refer to page 134, isswitched on automatically with the AUTO pro‐gram.At the same time, a condensation sensor con‐trols the program so as to prevent windowcondensation as much as possible.

Intensity of the AUTO programWith the AUTO program activated, the auto‐matic intensity control can be changed.

Press the left or right side of the but‐ton: decrease or increase the inten‐

sity.

The selected intensity is shown on the displayof the automatic climate control.

Maximum coolingPress button.The system is set to the lowest tem‐

perature, optimum air flow and air circulationmode.

Air flows out of the vents to the upper body re‐gion. The vents need to be open for this.The function is available above an externaltemperature of approx. 32 ℉/0 ℃ and with theengine running.Adjust air flow with the program active.

Seite 133

Climate control Controls

133Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Cooling functionThe car's interior can only be cooled with theengine running.

Press button.The air will be cooled and dehumidi‐

fied and, depending on the temperature set‐ting, warmed again.

Depending on the weather, the windshield andside windows may fog up briefly when the en‐gine is started.The cooling function is switched on automati‐cally with the AUTO program.When using the automatic climate control,condensation water, refer to page 154, devel‐ops that exits underneath the vehicle.

Automatic recirculated-air control/recirculated-air modeYou may respond to unpleasant odors or pollu‐tants in the immediate environment by tempo‐rarily suspending the supply of outside air. Thesystem then recirculates the air currentlywithin the vehicle.

Press button repeatedly to select anoperating mode:

▷ LEDs off: outside air flows in continuously.▷ Left LED on, automatic recirculated-air

control: a sensor detects pollutants in theoutside air and shuts off automatically.

▷ Right LED on, recirculated-air mode: thesupply of outside air into the vehicle is per‐manently blocked.

Recirculated air mode switches off automati‐cally at low external temperatures after a cer‐tain amount of time in order to avoid windowfogging.If the windows are fogged over, switch off therecirculated-air mode and press the AUTObutton to utilize the condensation sensor.Make sure that air can flow to the windshield.

Sufficient ventilationWhen remaining in the vehicle for an ex‐

tended period of time, ensure sufficient exter‐nal ventilation. Do not continuously use recir‐culated-air mode; otherwise the air quality inthe interior continuously deteriorates and win‐dow condensation increases.◀

Manual air distributionPress button repeatedly to select aprogram:

▷ Upper body region.▷ Upper body region and footwell.▷ Footwell.▷ Windows and footwell: driver's side only.▷ Windows, upper body region and footwell:

driver's side only.If the windows are fogged over, press theAUTO button to utilize the condensation sen‐sor.

Air flow, manualTo manually adjust air flow turn off AUTO pro‐gram first.

Press the left or right side of the but‐ton: decrease or increase air flow.

The selected air flow is shown on the display ofthe automatic climate control.The air flow of the automatic climate controlmay be reduced automatically to save batterypower.

Rear window defrosterPress button.The rear window defroster switches

off automatically after a certain period of time.

Seite 134

Controls Climate control

134Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Defrosts windows and removescondensation

Press button.Ice and condensation are quickly re‐

moved from the windshield and the front sidewindows.For this purpose, point the side vents onto theside windows as needed.

Adjust air flow with the program active.If the windows are fogged over, you can alsoswitch on the cooling function or press theAUTO button to utilize the condensation sen‐sor.

Switching the system on/off

Switch offPress the left button for the minimumspeed.

Switching onPress any button except▷ Rear window defroster.▷ Seat heating.

Microfilter/activated-charcoal filterIn external and recirculated air mode the mi‐crofilter/activated charcoal filter filters dust,pollen, and gaseous pollutants out of the air.This filter should be replaced during scheduledmaintenance, refer to page 191, of your vehi‐cle.

VentilationFront ventilation

▷ Lever for changing the air flow direction,arrow 1.

▷ Thumbwheels for opening and closing thevents continuously, arrows 2.

▷ Thumbwheel to vary the temperature inthe upper body region, arrow 3.Toward blue: colder.Toward red: warmer.The set interior temperature for the driverand passenger are not changed.

Adjusting the ventilation▷ Ventilation for cooling:

Direct vent in your direction when vehicle'sinterior is too hot.

▷ Draft-free ventilation:Adjust the vent to let the air flow past you.

Seite 135

Climate control Controls

135Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Ventilation in the rear

▷ Thumbwheel for continuous opening andclosing of the vents, arrow 1.

▷ Thumbwheel to vary the temperature, ar‐row 2.Toward blue: colder.Toward red: warmer.

▷ Lever for changing the air flow direction,arrow 3.

Parked-car ventilationThe conceptThe parked-car ventilation ventilates the vehi‐cle interior and lowers its temperature, ifneeded.The system can be switched on and off at anyexternal temperature, either directly or by us‐ing two preset reel-on times. It remainsswitched on for 30 minutes.Open the vents to allow air to flow out.

Switching on/off directlyOn the Control Display:

1. "Settings"2. "Climate"3. "Activate comf. ventilation"

The symbol on the automatic climate con‐trol flashes if the system is switched on.

Preselecting the reel-on timeOn the Control Display:

1. "Settings"2. "Climate"3. "Timer 1:" or "Timer 2:"4. Set the desired time.

Activating the reel-on timeOn the Control Display:

1. "Settings"2. "Climate"3. "Activate timer 1" or "Activate timer 2"

The symbol on the automatic climate con‐trol lights up when the reel-on time is acti‐vated.

The symbol on the automatic climate con‐trol flashes when the system has beenswitched on.The system will only be switched on within thenext 24 hours. After that, it needs to be reacti‐vated.

Seite 136

Controls Climate control

136Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Interior equipmentVehicle features and optionsThis chapter describes all standard, country-specific and optional features offered with theseries. It also describes features that are notnecessarily available in your car, e. g., due tothe selected options or country versions. Thisalso applies to safety-related functions andsystems. The respectively applicable countryprovisions must be observed when using therespective features and systems.

Universal Integrated RemoteControlThe conceptThe universal garage door opener can operateup to 3 functions of remote-controlled sys‐tems such as garage door drives or lightingsystems. The universal garage door opener re‐places up to 3 different hand-held transmitters.To operate the remote control, the buttons onthe interior rearview mirror must be program‐med with the desired functions. The hand-heldtransmitter for the particular system is requiredin order to program the remote control.

During programmingDuring programming and before activat‐

ing a device using the universal garage dooropener, ensure that there are no people, ani‐mals or objects in the area of the remote-con‐trolled device; otherwise, there is a risk of in‐jury or damage.Also follow the safety instructions of the hand-held transmitter.◀

Before selling the vehicle, delete the storedfunctions for the sake of security.

CompatibilityIf this symbol is printed on the packag‐ing or in the instructions of the systemto be controlled, the system is gener‐

ally compatible with the universal garage dooropener.If you have any questions, please contact:▷ Your service center.▷ www.homelink.com on the Internet.

HomeLink is a registered trademark of GentexCorporation.

Control elements on the interiorrearview mirror

▷ LED, arrow 1.▷ Buttons, arrow 2.▷ The hand-held transmitter, arrow 3, is re‐

quired for programming.

Programming

General information1. Switch on the ignition.2. Initial setup:

Press and hold the left and right button onthe interior rearview mirror simultaneouslyfor approximately 20 seconds until the LEDon the interior rearview mirror flashes. This

Seite 137

Interior equipment Controls

137Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

erases all programming of the buttons onthe interior rearview mirror.

3. Hold the hand-held transmitter for the sys‐tem to be controlled approx. 1 to 3 in/2.5 to8 cm away from the buttons of the interiorrearview mirror. The required distance de‐pends on the manual transmitter.

4. Simultaneously press and hold the buttonof the desired function on the hand-heldtransmitter and the button to be program‐med on the interior rearview mirror. TheLED on the interior rearview mirror will be‐gin flashing slowly.

5. Release both buttons as soon as the LEDflashes more rapidly. The LED flashingfaster indicates that the button on the inte‐rior rearview mirror has been programmed.If the LED does not flash faster after atleast 60 seconds, change the distance be‐tween the interior rearview mirror and thehand-held transmitter and repeat the step.Several more attempts at different distan‐ces may be necessary. Wait at least15 seconds between attempts.Canada: if programming with the hand-held transmitter was interrupted, holddown the interior rearview mirror buttonand repeatedly press and release thehand-held transmitter button for 2 sec‐onds.

6. To program other functions on other but‐tons, repeat steps 3 to 5.

The systems can be controlled using the inte‐rior rearview mirror buttons.

Special feature of the alternating-code wireless systemIf you are unable to operate the system afterrepeated programming, please check if thesystem to be controlled features an alternat‐ing-code system.Read the system's operating manual, or pressthe programmed button on the interior rear‐view mirror longer. If the LED on the interior

rearview mirror starts flashing rapidly and thenstays lit constantly for 2 seconds, the systemfeatures an alternating-code system. Flashingand continuous illumination of the LED will re‐peat for approximately 20 seconds.For systems with an alternating-code system,the universal garage door opener and the sys‐tem also have to be synchronized.Please read the operating manual to find outhow to synchronize the system.Synchronizing is easier with the aid of a sec‐ond person.To synchronize:

1. Park the vehicle within range of the re‐mote-controlled system.

2. Program the relevant button on the interiorrearview mirror as described.

3. Locate and press the synchronizing buttonon the system being programmed. Youhave approx. 30 seconds for the next step.

4. Hold down the programmed button on theinterior rearview mirror for approximately3 seconds and then release it. If necessary,repeat this step up to three times in orderto finish synchronization. Once synchroni‐zation is complete, the programmed func‐tion will be carried out.

Reprogramming individual buttons1. Switch on the ignition.2. Press and hold the interior rearview mirror

button to be programmed.3. As soon as the interior rearview mirror LED

starts flashing slowly, hold the hand-heldtransmitter for the system to be controlledapprox. 1 to 3 in/2.5 to 8 cm away from thebuttons of the interior rearview mirror. Therequired distance depends on the manualtransmitter.

Seite 138

Controls Interior equipment

138Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

4. Likewise, press and hold the button of thedesired function on the hand-held trans‐mitter.

5. Release both buttons as soon as the inte‐rior rearview mirror LED flashes more rap‐idly. The LED flashing faster indicates thatthe button on the interior rearview mirrorhas been programmed. The system canthen be controlled by the button on the in‐terior rearview mirror.If the LED does not flash faster after atleast 60 seconds, change the distance andrepeat the step. Several more attempts atdifferent distances may be necessary. Waitat least 15 seconds between attempts.Canada: if programming with the hand-held transmitter was interrupted, holddown the interior rearview mirror buttonand repeatedly press and release thehand-held transmitter button for 2 sec‐onds.

ControlsBefore operationBefore operating a system using the uni‐

versal garage door opener, ensure that thereare no people, animals, or objects within therange of movement of the remote-controlledsystem; otherwise, there is a risk of injury ordamage.Also follow the safety instructions of the hand-held transmitter.◀

The system, such as the garage door, can beoperated using the button on the interior rear‐view mirror while the engine is running or whenthe ignition is started. To do this, hold downthe button within receiving range of the systemuntil the function is activated. The interior rear‐view mirror LED stays lit while the wireless sig‐nal is being transmitted.

Deleting stored functionsPress and hold the left and right button on theinterior rearview mirror simultaneously for ap‐

proximately 20 seconds until the LED flashesrapidly. All stored functions are deleted. Thefunctions cannot be deleted individually.

Digital compassOverview

1 Control button2 Mirror display

Mirror displayThe point of the compass is displayed in themirror when driving straight.

Operating conceptVarious functions can be called up by pressingthe control button with a pointed object, suchas the tip of a ballpoint pen or similar object.The following setting options are displayed insuccession, depending on how long the con‐trol button is pressed:▷ Pressed briefly: turns display on/off.▷ 3 to 6 seconds: compass zone setting.▷ 6 to 9 seconds: compass calibration.▷ 9 to 12 seconds: left/right-hand steering

setting.▷ 12 to 15 seconds: language setting.

Setting the compass zonesSets the particular compass zones on the vehi‐cle so that the compass operates correctly; re‐fer to World map with compass zones.

Seite 139

Interior equipment Controls

139Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

World map with magnetic zones

Procedure1. Press and hold the control button for ap‐

prox. 3 to 4 seconds. The number of theset compass zone appears in the mirror.

2. To change the zone setting, press the con‐trol button quickly and repeatedly until thenumber of the compass zone that corre‐sponds with your location appears in themirror.

The set zone is stored automatically. The com‐pass is ready for use again after approximately10 seconds.

Calibrating the digital compassThe digital compass must be calibrated in theevent of the following:▷ The wrong compass point is displayed.▷ The point of the compass displayed does

not change despite changing the directionof travel.

▷ Not all points of the compass are dis‐played.

Procedure1. Make sure that there are no large metallic

objects or overhead power lines near thevehicle and that there is sufficient room todrive around in a circle.

2. Set the currently applicable compass zone.3. Press and hold the control button for ap‐

prox. 6 to 7 seconds so that "C" appearson the display. Next, drive in a completecircle at least once at a speed of no morethan 4 mph/7 km/h. If calibration is suc‐cessful, the "C" is replaced by the points ofthe compass.

Left/right-hand steeringThe digital compass is already set for right orleft-hand steering at the factory.

Setting the languagePress and hold the control button for approx.12 to 13 seconds. Briefly press the controlbutton again to reel between English "E" andGerman "O".

Seite 140

Controls Interior equipment

140Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Settings are stored automatically after approxi‐mately 10 seconds.

Sun visorGlare shieldFold the sun visor down or up.

Vanity mirrorA vanity mirror is located in the sun visor be‐hind a cover. When the cover is opened, themirror lighting switches on.

Ashtray/cigarette lighterAshtray

Opening

Raise cover.

EmptyingTake out the insert.

LighterDanger of burnsOnly hold the hot lighter by its knob; oth‐

erwise, there is a danger of getting burned.Switch off the ignition and take the remotecontrol with you when leaving the vehicle sothat children cannot use the lighter and burnthemselves.◀

Replace the cover after useReinsert the lighter or socket cover after

use, otherwise objects may get into the lightersocket or fixture and cause a short circuit.◀

The cigarette lighter is located in the centerconsole.

Push in the lighter.The lighter can be removed assoon as it pops back out.

Connecting electricaldevicesHints

Do not connect charging devices to the12 volt socket in the vehicle

Do not connect battery chargers to the fac‐tory-installed 12 volt sockets in the vehicle asthis may damage the vehicle battery due to anincreased power consumption.◀

Replace the cover after useReinsert the lighter or socket cover after

use, otherwise objects may get into the lightersocket or fixture and cause a short circuit.◀

Seite 141

Interior equipment Controls

141Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Sockets

General informationThe lighter socket can be used as a socket forelectrical equipment while the engine is run‐ning or when the ignition is switched on.

NoteThe total load of all sockets must not exceed140 watts at 12 volts.Do not damage the socket by using unsuitableconnectors.

Front center console

Remove the cover or cigarette lighter.

Rear center console

Remove the cover.

In the trunk

The socket is located on the left side in thetrunk.

USB interface for datatransferThe conceptConnection for importing and exporting dataon USB devices, e.g.:▷ Personal Profile settings, refer to page 35.▷ Music collection.▷ Importing Trips.

HintsObserve the following when connecting:▷ Do not use force when plugging the con‐

nector into the USB interface.▷ Do not connect devices such as fans or

lights to the USB interface.▷ Do not connect USB hard drives.▷ Do not use the USB interface for recharg‐

ing external devices.

Seite 142

Controls Interior equipment

142Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Without telephone: overview

The USB interface is located in the glove com‐partment.

With telephone: overview

The USB interface is located in the center arm‐rest.

Through-loading systemThe conceptThe cargo area can be enlarged by foldingdown the rear seat backrest.The rear seat backrest is divided into two partsat a ratio of 60 to 40.If equipped with through-loading system: therear seat backrest is divided in the ratio 40–20–40.The sides can be folded down separately or to‐gether.

HintsDanger of jammingBefore folding down the rear seat back‐

rests, ensure that the area of movement of thebackrests is clear. In particular, ensure that noone is located in or reaches into the area ofmovement of the rear seat backrests when themiddle section is folded down. Otherwise, in‐jury or damage may result.◀

Ensuring the stability of the child seatWhen installing child restraint systems,

make sure that the child seat is securely fas‐tened to the backrest of the seat. Angle andheadrest of the backrest might need to be ad‐justed or possibly be removed. Make sure thatall backrests are securely locked. Otherwisethe stability of the child seat can be affected,and there is an increased risk of injury becauseof unexpected movement of the seat back‐rest.◀

Retract the head restraint if needed be‐fore backrest is folded down

With folding head restraints, fold in the headrestraints before folding down the rear seatbackrests, or damage may result.◀

Opening1. Pull the corresponding lever in the cargo

area to release the rear seat backrest.

Seite 143

Interior equipment Controls

143Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

2. The unlocked backrest moves forwardslightly.

3. Fold backrest forward.

ClosingReturn the rear seat backrest to the uprightseating position and engage it.

Ensure that the lock is securely engagedMake sure that the lock engages prop‐

erly when folding back, otherwise transportedcargo could enter the car's interior during brak‐ing or evasive maneuvers and endanger thevehicle's occupants.◀

To secure cargo, refer to page 156, with netsor draw straps, the cargo area is fitted withlashing eyes.

Folding down the middle section

Reach into the recess and pull the middle sec‐tion forward.

Seite 144

Controls Interior equipment

144Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Storage compartmentsVehicle features and optionsThis chapter describes all standard, country-specific and optional features offered with theseries. It also describes features that are notnecessarily available in your car, e. g., due tothe selected options or country versions. Thisalso applies to safety-related functions andsystems. The respectively applicable countryprovisions must be observed when using therespective features and systems.

HintsNo loose objects in the car's interiorDo not stow any objects in the car's inte‐

rior without securing them; otherwise, theymay present a danger to occupants e.g., duringbraking and evasive maneuvers.◀

Do not place anti-slip mats on the dash‐board

Do not place anti-slip mats on the dashboard.The mat materials could damage the dash‐board.◀

Storage compartmentsThe following storage compartments are avail‐able in the vehicle interior:▷ Glove compartment on the front passenger

side, refer to page 145.▷ Glove compartment on the driver's side,

refer to page 146.▷ Compartments in the doors, refer to

page 146.▷ Without Smoker's package: Front storage

compartment, in front of the cupholders,refer to page 146.

▷ Storage compartment in the front centerarmrest, refer to page 146.

▷ Nets on the backrests of the front seats.▷ Storage compartment in the rear center

console, refer to page 147.▷ Storage compartment between the rear

seats, refer to page 147.

Glove compartmentFront passenger side

NoteClose the glove compartment again im‐mediately

Close the glove compartment immediately af‐ter use while driving; otherwise, injury may oc‐cur during accidents.◀

Opening

Pull the handle.The light in the glove compartment switcheson.

ClosingFold cover closed.

Seite 145

Storage compartments Controls

145Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

LockingThe glove compartment can be locked with anintegrated key to separately secure the trunklid, refer to page 41, e.g.This prevents access to the glove compart‐ment and to the trunk.After the glove compartment is locked, the re‐mote control can be handed over, such as at ahotel, without the integrated key.

Driver's side

NoteClose the glove compartment again im‐mediately

Close the glove compartment immediately af‐ter use while driving; otherwise, injury may oc‐cur during accidents.◀

Opening

Pull the handle.

ClosingFold cover closed.

Compartments in the doorsDo not stow any breakable objectsDo not store any breakable objects, e. g.

glass bottles, in the compartments, or there isan increased risk of injury in the event of an ac‐cident.◀

Front storage compartment

A storage compartment is located in the centerarmrest in front of the cup holders.

Center armrestFrontA storage compartment is located in the centerarmrest between the front seats.

Opening

Fold the center armrest up.

RepositioningCenter armrest can be pushed forwards orbackwards. It engages in the end positions.

Connection for an external audiodevice

An external audio device, e.g.,an MP3 player, can be con‐nected via the AUX-IN port or

Seite 146

Controls Storage compartments

146Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

the USB audio interface in the center armrest.

Storage compartment in therearA storage compartment is located in the centerarmrest.

Storage compartmentbetween the rear seatsThere is a storage compartment between therear seats.

CupholdersHints

Shatter-proof containers and no hotdrinks

Use light and shatter-proof containers and donot transport hot drinks. Otherwise, there isthe increased danger of injury in an accident.◀

Unsuitable containersDo not forcefully push unsuitable con‐

tainers into the cupholders. This may result indamage.◀

Front

RearIn the center armrest.

Pull the center armrest forward at the strap.To open: press the button.To close: push both covers back in, one afterthe other.

Pushing back the coversPush back the covers before folding up

the center armrest; otherwise, the cupholdercould become damaged.◀

Clothes hooksDo not obstruct viewWhen suspending clothing from the

hooks, ensure that it will not obstruct the driv‐er's view.◀

No heavy objectsDo not hang heavy objects from the

hooks; otherwise, they may present a dangerto passengers during braking and evasive ma‐neuvers.◀

The clothes hooks are located in the rear.

Storage compartments in thetrunkStorage compartmentA storage compartment is located on the leftside.Located on the right side is a storage compart‐ment for the first aid kit, refer to page 203.

Seite 147

Storage compartments Controls

147Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Net for storage compartmentSmaller objects can be stored in the net ofright storage compartment.

Multi-function hookLightweight objects onlyOnly hang lightweight objects, e.g. shop‐

ping bags, from the multifunction hooks. Oth‐erwise, there is a danger of objects flying aboutduring braking and evasive maneuvers.Only transport heavy luggage in the trunk if ithas been appropriately secured.◀

A multi-function hook is located on each sideof the trunk. The multi-function hooks can beloaded up to a max. of 8.8 lbs/4 kg.

Lashing eyes in the trunkTo secure the cargo, refer to page 156, thereare two or four lashing eyes in the cargo area.

Floor netThe floor net can also be used to secure thecargo, refer to page 156, and store smallparts.

Seite 148

Controls Storage compartments

148Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Seite 149

Storage compartments Controls

149Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Driving tipsThis chapter provides you with information

useful in dealing with specific driving andoperating modes.

Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Things to remember when drivingVehicle features and optionsThis chapter describes all standard, country-specific and optional features offered with theseries. It also describes features that are notnecessarily available in your car, e. g., due tothe selected options or country versions. Thisalso applies to safety-related functions andsystems. The respectively applicable countryprovisions must be observed when using therespective features and systems.

Breaking-in periodGeneral informationMoving parts need time to adjust to one an‐other (break-in time).The following instructions will help accomplisha long vehicle life and good efficiency.During break-in, do not use the Launch Con‐trol, refer to page 74.

Engine, transmission, and axle drive

Up to 1,200 miles/2,000 kmDo not exceed the maximum engine and roadspeed:▷ For gasoline engine 4,500 rpm and

100 mph/160 km/h.Avoid full load or kickdown under all circum‐stances.

From 1,200 miles/2,000 kmThe engine and vehicle speed can gradually beincreased.

TiresTire traction is not optimal due to manufactur‐ing circumstances when tires are brand-new;

they achieve their full traction potential after abreak-in time.Drive conservatively for the first200 miles/300 km.

Brake systemBrakes require an initial break-in period of ap‐prox. 300 miles/500 km to achieve optimal per‐formance between brake discs and brakepads. Drive moderately during this break-in pe‐riod.

ClutchThe function of the clutch reaches its optimallevel only after a distance driven of approx.300 miles/500 km. During this break-in period,engage the clutch gently.

Following part replacementThe same break-in procedures should be ob‐served if any of the components above-men‐tioned have to be renewed in the course of thevehicle's operating life.

General driving notesClosing the trunk lid

Drive with the trunk lid closedOnly drive with the tailgate closed; other‐

wise, in the event of an accident or braking andevasive maneuvers, passengers and other traf‐fic may be injured, and the vehicle may bedamaged. In addition, exhaust fumes may en‐ter the vehicle interior.◀

If driving with the tailgate open cannot beavoided:▷ Close all windows and the glass sunroof.▷ Greatly increase the air flow from the vents.▷ Drive moderately.

Seite 152

Driving tips Things to remember when driving

152Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Hot exhaust systemHot exhaust systemHigh temperatures are generated in the

exhaust system.Do not remove the heat shields installed andnever apply undercoating to them. Make surethat flammable materials, e. g. hay, leaves,grass, etc. do not come in contact with the hotexhaust system while driving, while in idle po‐sition mode, or when parked. Such contactcould lead to a fire, resulting in an increasedrisk of serious personal injury as well as prop‐erty damage.Do not touch hot exhaust pipes; otherwise,there is a danger of getting burned.◀

Mobile communication devices in thevehicle

Mobile communication devices in the ve‐hicle

It is not recommended to use mobile phones,such as mobile phones, in the vehicle interiorwithout a direct connection to an external aer‐ial. Otherwise, the vehicle's electronics andmobile communication devices can interferewith each other. In addition, there is no assur‐ance that the radiation generated during trans‐mission will be conducted away from the vehi‐cle interior.◀

HydroplaningHydroplaningWhen driving on wet or slushy roads, re‐

duce your speed to prevent hydroplaning.◀

On wet or slushy roads, a wedge of water canform between the tires and road surface.This phenomenon is referred to as hydroplan‐ing. It is characterized by a partial or completeloss of contact between the tires and the roadsurface, ultimately undermining your ability tosteer and brake the vehicle.

Driving through waterObserve water level and speedDo not exceed the maximum water level

and maximum speed; otherwise, the vehicle'sengine, the electrical systems and the trans‐mission may be damaged.◀

Drive though calm water only and only if it isnot deeper than 9.8 inches/25 cm and at thisheight, no faster than walking speed, up to3 mph/5 km/h.

Braking safelyYour vehicle is equipped with ABS as a stand‐ard feature.Applying the brakes fully is the most effectiveway of braking in situations needed.Steering is still responsive. You can still avoidany obstacles with a minimum of steering ef‐fort.Pulsation of the brake pedal and sounds fromthe hydraulic circuits indicate that ABS is in itsactive mode.In certain braking situations, the perforatedbrake discs can cause functional problems.However, this has no effect on the perform‐ance and operational reliability of the brake.

Objects within the range of movementof the pedals

No objects in the area around the pedalsKeep floor mats, carpets, and any other

objects out of the pedal area; otherwise, thefunction of the pedals could be impeded whiledriving and create the risk of an accident.Do not place additional floor mats over existingmats or other objects.Only use floor mats that have been approvedfor the vehicle and can be properly attached tofloor.Ensure that the floor mats are securely fas‐tened again after they were removed for clean‐ing, e.g.◀

Seite 153

Things to remember when driving Driving tips

153Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Driving in wet conditionsWhen roads are wet, salted, or in heavy rain,press brake pedal ever so gently every fewmiles.Ensure that this action does not endangerother traffic.The heat generated in this process helps drythe brake discs and pads.In this way braking efficiency will be availablewhen you need it.

HillsAvoid stressing the brakesAvoid placing excessive stress on the

brake system. Light but consistent brake pres‐sure can lead to high temperatures, brakeswearing out and possibly even brake failure.◀

Do not drive in neutralDo not drive in neutral or with the engine

stopped, as doing so disables engine braking.In addition, steering and brake assist are un‐available with the engine stopped.◀

Drive long or steep downhill gradients in thegear that requires least braking efforts. Other‐wise the brakes may overheat and reducebrake efficiency.You can increase the engine's braking effectby shifting down, going all the way to first gear,if needed.

Brake disc corrosionBrake disc corrosion and contamination of thebrake pads are favored by:▷ Low mileage.▷ Extended periods when the vehicle is not

used at all.▷ Infrequent use of the brakes.Corrosion will built up when the maximumpressure applied to the brake pads duringbraking is not reached - thus discs don't getcleaned.

Corrosion buildup on the brake discs will causea pulsating effect on the brakes in their re‐sponse - generally that cannot be corrected.

Condensation under the parkedvehicleWhen using the automatic climate control,condensation water develops collecting under‐neath the vehicle.These traces of water under the vehicle arenormal.

Seite 154

Driving tips Things to remember when driving

154Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

LoadingVehicle features and optionsThis chapter describes all standard, country-specific and optional features offered with theseries. It also describes features that are notnecessarily available in your car, e. g., due tothe selected options or country versions. Thisalso applies to safety-related functions andsystems. The respectively applicable countryprovisions must be observed when using therespective features and systems.

HintsOverloading the vehicleTo avoid exceeding the approved ca‐

pacity of the tires, never overload the vehicle.Overloading can lead to overheating and in‐creases the rate at which damage develops in‐side the tires. This could result in a suddenloss of tire inflation pressure.◀

No fluids in the cargo areaMake sure that fluids do not leak into the

cargo area; otherwise, the vehicle may be dam‐aged.◀

Heavy and hard objectsDo not stow any heavy and hard objects

in the car's interior without securing them; oth‐erwise, they may present a danger to occu‐pants, e.g., during braking and evasive maneu‐vers.◀

Determining the load limit1. Locate the following statement on your ve‐

hicle’s placard:▷ The combined weight of occupants

and cargo should never exceed XXX kgor YYY lbs. Otherwise, damage to the

vehicle and unstable driving situationsmay result.

2. Determine the combined weight of thedriver and passengers that will be riding inyour vehicle.

3. Subtract the combined weight of the driverand passengers from XXX kilograms orYYY pounds.

4. The resulting figure equals the availableamount of cargo and luggage load ca‐pacity.For example, if the YYY amount equals1,000 lbs and there will be four 150 lbspassengers in your vehicle, the amount ofavailable cargo and luggage load capacityis 400 lbs: 1,000 lbs minus 600 lbs =400 lbs.

5. Determine the combined weight of lug‐gage and cargo being loaded on the vehi‐cle. That weight may not safely exceed theavailable cargo and luggage load capacitycalculated in Step 4.

Seite 155

Loading Driving tips

155Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Load

The maximum load is the sum of the weight ofthe occupants and the cargo.The greater the weight of the occupants, theless cargo that can be transported.

Stowing cargo▷ Cover sharp edges and corners on the

cargo.▷ Heavy cargo: stow as far forward as possi‐

ble, directly behind and at the bottom ofthe rear passenger seat backrests.

▷ Very heavy cargo: when the rear seat is notoccupied, secure each of the outer safetybelts in the opposite buckle.

▷ If necessary, fold down the rear backreststo stow cargo.

▷ Do not stack cargo above the top edge ofthe backrests.

Securing cargoLashing eyes in the trunk

To secure the cargo there are two or four lash‐ing eyes in the cargo area.

Floor netThe floor net can also be used to secure cargoand store small parts.

Hook the floor net into the fittings in the trunkfloor.

Securing cargoSecuring cargoStow and secure the cargo as described;

otherwise it may present a danger to the occu‐pants, e.g., during braking and evasive maneu‐vers.◀

▷ Smaller and lighter items: secure with re‐taining straps or draw straps.

▷ Larger and heavy objects: secure withcargo straps.

Attach the cargo straps, retaining straps ordraw straps to the lashing eyes in the trunk.

Seite 156

Driving tips Loading

156Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Roof-mounted luggage rackNoteRoof racks are available as special accessories.

SecuringFollow the installation instructions of the roofrack.

Roof drip rail with flaps

The anchorage points are located in the roofdrip rail above the doors.Fold the cover outward.

LoadingBe sure that adequate clearance is maintainedfor tilting and opening the glass sunroof.Because roof racks raise the vehicle's centerof gravity when loaded, they have a major ef‐fect on vehicle handling and steering re‐sponse.Therefore, note the following when loadingand driving:▷ Do not exceed the approved roof/axle

loads and the approved gross vehicleweight.

▷ Distribute the roof load uniformly.▷ The roof load should not extend past the

loading area.▷ Always place the heaviest pieces on the

bottom.▷ Secure the roof luggage firmly, e.g., tie

with ratchet straps.

▷ Do not let objects project into the openingpath of the trunk lid.

▷ Drive cautiously and avoid sudden acceler‐ation and braking maneuvers. Take cornersgently.

Seite 157

Loading Driving tips

157Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Saving fuelVehicle features and optionsThis chapter describes all standard, country-specific and optional features offered with theseries. It also describes features that are notnecessarily available in your car, e. g., due tothe selected options or country versions. Thisalso applies to safety-related functions andsystems. The respectively applicable countryprovisions must be observed when using therespective features and systems.

General informationYour vehicle contains advanced technology forthe reduction of fuel consumption and emis‐sions.Fuel consumption depends on a number of dif‐ferent factors.Carrying out certain measures, such as a mod‐erate driving style and regular maintenance,can influence fuel consumption and the envi‐ronmental impact.

Remove unnecessary cargoAdditional weight increases fuel consumption.

Remove attached partsfollowing useRemove auxiliary mirrors, roof or rear luggageracks which are no longer required followinguse.Attached parts on the vehicle impair the aero‐dynamics and increase the fuel consumption.

Close the windows and glasssunroofDriving with the glass sunroof and windowsopen results in increased air resistance andthereby reduces the range.

TiresGeneral informationTires can affect fuel consumption in variousways, e.g., tire size may influence fuel con‐sumption.

Check the tire inflation pressureregularlyCheck and, if needed, correct the tire inflationpressure at least twice a month and beforestarting on a long trip.Low tire inflation pressure increases rolling re‐sistance and thus raises fuel consumption andtire wear.

Drive away immediatelyDo not wait for the engine to warm-up whilethe vehicle remains stationary. Start drivingright away, but at moderate engine speeds.This is the quickest way of warming the coldengine up to operating temperature.

Look well ahead whendrivingAvoid unnecessary acceleration and braking.By maintaining a suitable distance to the vehi‐cle driving ahead of you.Driving smoothly and proactively reduces fuelconsumption.

Seite 158

Driving tips Saving fuel

158Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Avoid high engine speedsAs a rule: driving at low engine speeds lowersfuel consumption and reduces wear.Use 1st gear to get the vehicle moving. Start‐ing with the 2nd gear, accelerate rapidly. Whenaccelerating, shift up before reaching high en‐gine speeds.When you reach the desired speed, shift intothe highest applicable gear and drive with theengine speed as low as possible and at a con‐stant speed.If necessary, observe the gear shift indicator ofthe vehicle, refer to page 83.

Use coastingWhen approaching a red light, take your footoff the accelerator and let the vehicle coast toa halt.For going downhill take your foot off the accel‐erator and let the vehicle roll.The flow of fuel is interrupted while coasting.

Switch off the engine duringlonger stopsSwitch off the engine during longer stops, e.g.,at traffic lights, railroad crossings or in trafficcongestion.

Auto Start/Stop functionThe Auto Start/Stop function of your vehicleautomatically switches off the engine during astop.If the engine is switched off and then restartedrather than leaving the engine running con‐stantly, fuel consumption and emissions arereduced. Savings can begin within a few sec‐onds of switching off the engine.In addition, fuel consumption is also deter‐mined by other factors, such as driving style,

road conditions, maintenance or environmentalfactors.

Switch off any functions thatare not currently neededFunctions such as seat heating and the rearwindow defroster require a lot of energy andreduce the range, especially in city and stop-and-go traffic.Reel off these functions if they are not needed.The ECO PRO driving program supports theenergy conserving use of comfort features.These functions are automatically deactivatedpartially or completely.

Have maintenance carriedoutHave vehicles maintained regularly to achieveoptimal vehicle efficiency and operating life.The maintenance should be carried out byyour service center.Also note the BMW Maintenance System, referto page 191.

ECO PROThe conceptECO PRO supports a driving style that saveson fuel consumption. For this purpose, the en‐gine control and comfort features, e. g. the cli‐mate control output, are adjusted.Under certain conditions the engine is auto‐matically decoupled from the transmission inthe D selector lever position. The vehicle con‐tinues traveling with the engine idling to re‐duce fuel consumption. Selector lever positionD remains engaged.In addition, context-sensitive instructions aredisplayed to assist with an optimized fuel con‐sumption driving style.

Seite 159

Saving fuel Driving tips

159Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

The achieved extended range is displayed inthe instrument cluster as bonus range.

OverviewThe system includes the followingEfficientDynamics functions and displays:▷ ECO PRO bonus range, refer to page 160.▷ ECO PRO tips driving instruction, refer to

page 161▷ ECO PRO climate control, refer to

page 160.▷ ECO PRO coasting driving status, refer to

page 162.▷ ECO PRO driving style analysis, refer to

page 163.

Activate ECO PROPress button repeatedly until ECOPRO is displayed in the instrument

cluster.

Configuring ECO PRO

Via the Driving Dynamics Control1. Activate ECO PRO.2. "Configure ECO PRO"3. Configure the program.

Via the iDrive1. "Settings"2. "ECO PRO mode"Or

1. "Settings"2. "Driving mode"3. "Configure ECO PRO"Configure the program.

ECO PRO Tip▷ "Tip at:":

Adjust the ECO PRO speed.

▷ "ECO PRO speed warning":The output is reduced once the set ECOPRO speed is reached.

CoastingFuel-efficiency can be optimized by disengag‐ing the engine and Coasting, refer topage 162, with the engine idling.This function is only available in ECO PROmode.

ECO PRO climate control"ECO PRO climate control"Climate control is set to be fuel-efficient.By making a slight change to the set tempera‐ture, or slowly adjusting the rate of heating orcooling of the car's interior, fuel consumptioncan be economized.The mirror heating is made available when out‐side temperatures are very cold.

ECO PRO potentialShows potential savings with the current set‐tings in percentages.

Display in the instrument cluster

ECO PRO bonus rangeAn adjusted driving style helpsyou extend your driving range.This may be displayed as thebonus range in the instrumentcluster.

The bonus range is shown in the range display.The bonus range is automatically reset everytime the vehicle is refueled.

Seite 160

Driving tips Saving fuel

160Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Efficiency displayDisplay in the instrument cluster

Display in the instrument cluster with extendedrange

A mark in the efficiency display informs aboutthe current driving style.Mark in the area of arrow 1: display of the en‐ergy recovered by coasting or when braking.Mark in the area of arrow 2: display when ac‐celerating.Your driving style's efficiency is shown by thebar's color:▷ Blue display: efficient driving style as long

as the mark moves within the blue range.▷ Gray display: adjust driving style, e. g. by

backing off the accelerator pedal.The display switches to blue as soon as allconditions for fuel-efficiency-optimized drivingare met.

ECO PRO tip, driving tipThe arrow indicates that the drivingstyle can be adjusted to be more fuelefficient by backing off the accelerator

for instance.

NoteThe efficiency display and ECO PRO tips in theinstrument cluster appear when the ECO PROdisplay is activated.Activating driving style and ECO PRO tips:

1. "Settings"2. "Instrument cluster"3. "ECO PRO Info"

ECO PRO tip, symbolsAn additional symbol and text instructions aredisplayed.

Symbol Measure

For efficient driving back off the ac‐celerator or delay accelerating to al‐low time to assess road conditions.

Reduce speed to the selected ECOPRO speed.

Steptronic transmission: shift fromM/S to D.

Steptronic transmission/manualtransmission: follow shifting instruc‐tions.

Manual transmission: engage neu‐tral for engine stop.

Seite 161

Saving fuel Driving tips

161Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Indications on the Control Display

EfficientDynamicsInformation on fuel consumption and technol‐ogy can be displayed while driving.

1. "Vehicle info"2. "EfficientDynamics"

Displaying fuel consumption historyThe average fuel consumption can be dis‐played within an adjustable time frame.Vertical bars show consumption for the se‐lected time frame.Trip interruptions are represented below thebar on the time axis.

"Consumption history"

Adjusting fuel consumption historytime frame

Select the symbol.

Resetting fuel consumption history1. Open "Options".2. "Reset consumption history"

Displaying EfficientDynamics infoThe current efficiency can be displayed.

"EfficientDynamics info"The following systems are displayed:▷ Auto Start/Stop function.▷ Energy recovery.▷ Climate control output.▷ Coasting.

Display ECO PRO tips "ECO PRO Tips"

Settings are stored for the profile currently inuse.

Coasting

The conceptThe system helps to conserve fuel.To do this, under certain conditions the engineis automatically decoupled from the transmis‐sion when selector lever position D is set. Thevehicle continues traveling with the engineidling to reduce fuel consumption. Selectorlever position D remains engaged.This driving condition is referred to as coast‐ing.As soon as you step on the brake or accelera‐tor pedal, the engine is automatically coupledagain.

HintsCoasting is a component of the ECO PRO, re‐fer to page 159, driving mode.Coasting is automatically activated when ECOPRO mode is called via the Driving DynamicsControl.The function is available in a certain speedrange.A proactively driving style helps the driver touse the function as often as possible and sup‐ports the fuel-conserving effect of coasting.

Safety modeThe function is not available under one of thefollowing conditions.▷ DSC OFF or TRACTION activated.▷ Driving in the dynamic limit range and on

steep uphill or downhill grades.▷ Battery charge status temporarily too low

or vehicle electrical system drawing exces‐sive current.

▷ Cruise control activated.

Functional requirementsIn ECO PRO mode, this function is available ina speed range from approximately 30 mph, ap‐

Seite 162

Driving tips Saving fuel

162Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

prox. 50 km/h to 100 mph, approx. 160 km/h, ifthe following conditions are met:▷ Accelerator pedal and brake pedal are not

operated.▷ The selector lever is in selector lever posi‐

tion D.▷ Engine and transmission are at operating

temperature.The driving status Coast can be influencedwith the shift paddles.

Display

Display in the instrument cluster

The mark in the efficiency display is backlit inblue and is located at the zero point. The tach‐ometer approximately indicates idle speed.The coasting point indicator is illuminated atthe zero point during coasting.

Display in the instrument cluster withextended range

The mark in the efficiency dis‐play below the tachometer isbacklit in blue and is located atthe zero point. The tachometerapproximately indicates idle

speed.The coasting point indicator is illuminated atthe zero point during coasting.

Indications on the Control DisplayThe Coasting driving condition is displayed inEfficientDynamics Info while this driving modeis active.The distance traveled in the Coasting drivingcondition is indicated by a counter.

Color code blue, arrow 1, and symbol, arrow 2:driving condition Coasting.

Displaying EfficientDynamics info1. "Vehicle info"2. "EfficientDynamics"3. "EfficientDynamics info"

Deactivating the system manuallyThe function can be deactivated in the Config‐ure ECO PRO, refer to page 160, menu, e.g., touse the braking effect of the engine when trav‐eling downhill.Settings are stored for the profile currently inuse.

ECO PRO driving style analysis

The conceptIn this situation the system helps develop anespecially efficient driving style and to con‐serve fuel.For this purpose, the driving style is analyzed.The assessment is done in various categoriesand is displayed on the Control Display.Using this indication, the individual drivingstyle can be oriented toward conserving fuel.

Seite 163

Saving fuel Driving tips

163Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

The last fifteen minutes of a trip are evaluated.The range of the vehicle can be extended byan efficient driving style.This gain in range is displayed as a bonusrange in the instrument cluster and on theControl Display.

Functional requirementThe function is only available in ECO PROmode.

Calling up ECO PRO driving styleanalysis1. Activate ECO PRO.2. "EfficientDynamics"3. Select the symbol.

Display on the Control Display

The display of the ECO PRO driving style anal‐ysis consists of a symbolized route and alookup table.The road symbolizes the efficiency of the driv‐ing style. The more efficient the driving style,the smoother the depicted route becomes, ar‐row 1.The table of values contains stars. The moreefficient the driving style, the more stars are in‐cluded in the table and the faster the bonusrange increases, arrow 2.If, on the other hand, the driving style is ineffi‐cient, a wavy road and a reduced number ofstars is displayed.To assist with an efficient driving style, ECOPRO tips are displayed during driving.

Tips about the energy saving driving style,Conserving fuel, refer to page 158.

Seite 164

Driving tips Saving fuel

164Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Seite 165

Saving fuel Driving tips

165Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

MobilityIn order to always ensure your mobility, you will

find important information on operating fluids,wheels and tires, maintenance and Roadside

Assistance in the following.

Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

RefuelingVehicle features and optionsThis chapter describes all standard, country-specific and optional features offered with theseries. It also describes features that are notnecessarily available in your car, e. g., due tothe selected options or country versions. Thisalso applies to safety-related functions andsystems. The respectively applicable countryprovisions must be observed when using therespective features and systems.

HintsObserve the fuel recommendation, refer topage 170, prior to refueling.

Refuel promptlyRefuel no later than at a range of

30 miles/50 km or engine operation might failand damage might occur.◀

Fuel lidOpening1. Briefly press the rear edge of the fuel filler

flap.

2. Turn the tank lid counterclockwise.

3. Place the tank lid in the bracket attached tothe fuel filler flap.

Closing1. Fit the lid and turn it clockwise until you

clearly hear a click.2. Close the fuel filler flap.

Do not pinch the retaining strapDo not pinch the retaining strap attached

to the lid; otherwise, the lid cannot be closedproperly and fuel vapors can escape.◀

Manually unlocking fuel filler flapIn the event of an electrical malfunction, e.g.The release is located in the trunk.

Seite 168

Mobility Refueling

168Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Pull the green knob with the fuel pump symbol.This releases the fuel filler flap.

Observe the following whenrefuelingThe fuel tank is full when the filler nozzle clicksoff the first time.

Do not overfill the fuel tankDo not overfill the fuel tank; otherwise

fuel may eslide, causing harm to the environ‐ment and damaging the vehicle.◀

Handling fuelsObserve safety regulations posted at the

gas station.◀

Seite 169

Refueling Mobility

169Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

FuelVehicle features and optionsThis chapter describes all standard, country-specific and optional features offered with theseries. It also describes features that are notnecessarily available in your car, e. g., due tothe selected options or country versions. Thisalso applies to safety-related functions andsystems. The respectively applicable countryprovisions must be observed when using therespective features and systems.

Fuel recommendationNote

General fuel qualityEven fuels that conform to the specifica‐

tions can be of low quality. This may cause en‐gine problems, for instance poor engine start-up behavior, poor handling and/or poorperformance. Switch gas stations or use abrand name fuel with a higher octane rating.◀

GasolineFor the best fuel efficiency, the gasolineshould be sulfur-free or very low in sulfur con‐tent.Fuels that are marked on the gas pump as con‐taining metal must not be used.

Refuel only with unleaded gasoline with‐out metallic additives.

Do not refuel with any leaded gasoline or gaso‐line with metallic additives, e. g. manganese oriron, as this can cause permanent damage tothe catalytic converter and other compo‐nents.◀

Fuels with a maximum ethanol content of10 %, i. e., E10, may be used for refueling.

Ethanol should satisfy the following qualitystandards:US: ASTM 4806–xxCAN: CGSB-3.511–xxxx: comply with the current standard in eachcase.

Do not use a fuel with a higher percent‐age of ethanol

Do not use a fuel with a higher ethanol per‐centage than recommended or one with othertypes of alcohol, e.g. M5 to M100; otherwisethis could damage the engine and fuel supplysystem.◀

Recommended fuel gradeBMW recommends AKI 91.

Minimum fuel gradeBMW recommends AKI 89.

Minimum fuel gradeDo not use any gasoline below the mini‐

mum fuel grade as this may impair engine per‐formance.◀

If you use gasoline with this minimum AKI Rat‐ing, the engine may produce knocking soundswhen starting at high outside temperatures.This has no effect on the engine life.

Fuel qualityThe use of poor-quality fuels may result

in harmful engine deposits or damage. Addi‐tionally, problems relating to drivability, start‐ing and stalling, especially under certain envi‐ronmental conditions such as high ambienttemperature and high altitude, may occur.If drivability problems are encountered, we rec‐ommend switching to a high quality gasolinebrand and a higher octane grade — AKI num‐ber — for a few tank fills. To avoid harmful en‐

Seite 170

Mobility Fuel

170Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

gine deposits, it is highly recommended topurchase gasoline from Top Tier retailers.Failure to comply with these recommendationsmay result in the need for unscheduled main‐tenance.◀

Seite 171

Fuel Mobility

171Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Wheels and tiresVehicle features and optionsThis chapter describes all standard, country-specific and optional features offered with theseries. It also describes features that are notnecessarily available in your car, e. g., due tothe selected options or country versions. Thisalso applies to safety-related functions andsystems. The respectively applicable countryprovisions must be observed when using therespective features and systems.

Tire inflation pressureSafety informationThe tire characteristics and tire inflation pres‐sure influence the following:▷ The service life of the tires.▷ Road safety.▷ Driving comfort.

Checking the tire inflation pressureCheck the tire inflation pressure regularlyRegularly check the tire inflation pres‐

sure, and correct it as needed: at least twice amonth and before a long trip. If you fail to ob‐serve this precaution, you may be driving ontires with incorrect tire pressures, a conditionthat may not only compromise your vehicle'sdriving stability, but also lead to tire damageand the risk of an accident.◀

Tires have a natural, consistent loss of tire in‐flation pressure.Tires heat up while driving, and the tire infla‐tion pressure increases along with the tire'stemperature. The tire inflation pressure speci‐fications relate to cold tires or tires with theambient temperature.

Only check the tire inflation pressure when thetires are cold. This means after driving no morethan 1.25 miles/2 km or when the vehicle hasbeen parked for at least 2 hours.The displays of inflation devices may under-read by up to 1.45 psi/0.1 bar.For Flat Tire Monitor: after correcting the tireinflation pressure, reinitialize the Flat TireMonitor.For Tire Pressure Monitor: after correcting thetire inflation pressure, reset the Tire PressureMonitor.

Tire inflation pressure specificationsThe tire inflation pressure table, refer topage 173, contains all tire inflation pressurespecifications for the specified tire sizes at theambient temperature. Tire inflation pressurespecifications apply to approved tire sizes andrecommended tire brands. This informationcan be obtained from your service center.To identify the correct tire inflation pressure,please note the following:▷ Tire sizes of your vehicle.▷ Maximum permitted driving speed.

Tire inflation pressures up to100 mph/160 km/hFor speeds of up to 100 mph/160 km/h and foroptimum driving comfort, note the pressurevalues in the tire inflation pressure table, referto page 173, and adjust as necessary.

Seite 172

Mobility Wheels and tires

172Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

These pressure values can also be found onthe tire inflation pressure label on the driver'sdoor pillar.

Maximum permissible speedDo not exceed 100 mph/160 km/h; other‐

wise, tire damage and accidents may result.◀

Tire inflation pressure values up to100 mph/160 km/h

228i, 228i xDrive

Tire size Pressure specifications inbar/PSI

Specifications inbar/PSI with coldtires

225/45 R 17 91 HM+S RSC

2.2 / 32 2.3 / 33

205/50 R 17 89V M+S A/S RSC205/50 R 17 89 HM+S RSC

2.2 / 32 2.5 / 36

225/40 R 18 92 VM+S XL A/S RSC225/40 R 18 92 VM+S XL RSC

2.2 / 32 2.6 / 38

Tire size Pressure specifications inbar/PSI

Front: 225/45R 17 91 W RSCRear: 245/40R 17 91 W RSC

2.2 / 32-

-2.3 / 33

Front: 225/40R 18 88 Y RSCRear: 245/35R 18 88 Y RSC

2.2 / 32-

-2.6 / 38

Front: 225/35R 19 88 Y XLRSCRear: 245/30R 19 89 Y XLRSC

2.5 / 36-

-2,9/ 42

Front: 225/40 R18 88 Y StdRear: 245/35 R18 92 Y XL Std

2.2 / 32-

-2.6 / 38

Emergencywheel:T 125/80 R 17 99M

Speed up to a max. of50 mph / 80 km/h4.2 / 60

M235i, M235i xDrive

Tire size Pressure specifications inbar/PSI

Specifications inbar/PSI with coldtires

205/50 R 17 89 HM+S RSC225/45 R 17 91 HM+S RSC

2.2 / 32 2.6 / 38

Seite 173

Wheels and tires Mobility

173Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Tire size Pressure specifications inbar/PSI

225/40 R 18 92 VM+S XL A/S RSC225/40 R 18 92 VM+S XL RSC

2.3 / 33 2.6 / 38

Front: 225/40 R18 88 Y StdRear: 245/35 R18 92 Y XL Std

2.3 / 33-

-2.6 / 38

Front: 225/40R 18 88 Y RSCRear: 245/35R 18 88 Y RSC

2.3 / 33-

-2.6 / 38

Front: 225/35R 19 88 Y XLRSCRear: 245/30R 19 89 Y XLRSC

2.6 / 38-

-2.9 /42

Emergencywheel:T 125/80 R 17 99M

Speed up to a max. of50 mph / 80 km/h4.2 / 60

Tire inflation pressures at max.speeds above 100 mph/160 km/h

Speeds above 100 mph/160 km/hIn order to drive at maximum speeds in

excess of 100 mph/160 km/h, please observe,and, if necessary, adjust tire pressures forspeeds exceeding 100 mph/160 km/h from therelevant table on the following pages. Other‐wise tire damage and accidents could occur.◀

Tire inflation pressure values over100 mph/160 km/h

228i, 228i xDriveWithout high-speed tuning feature

Tire size Pressure specifications inbar/PSI

Specifications inbar/PSI with coldtires

225/45 R 17 91 HM+S RSC

2.2 / 32 2.6 / 38

205/50 R 17 89V M+S A/S RSC225/40 R 18 92 VM+S XL A/S RSC205/50 R 17 89 HM+S RSC225/40 R 18 92 VM+S XL RSC

2.4 / 35 2.8 / 41

Front: 225/45R 17 91 W RSCRear: 245/40 R 1791 W RSC

2.2 / 32-

-2.5 / 36

Front: 225/40R 18 88 Y RSCRear: 245/35 R 1888 Y RSC

2.2 / 32-

-2.6 / 38

Front: 225/35R 19 88 Y XL RSCRear: 245/30 R 1989 Y XL RSC

2.5 / 36-

-2.9 /42

Front: 225/40 R18 88 Y StdRear: 245/35 R 1892 Y XL Std

2.2 / 32-

-2.6 / 38

Emergencywheel:T 125/80 R 17 99M

Speed up to a max. of50 mph / 80 km/h4.2 / 60

With high-speed tuning feature

Seite 174

Mobility Wheels and tires

174Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Tire size Pressure specifications inbar/PSI

Specifications inbar/PSI with coldtires

225/45 R 17 91H M+S RSC

2.5 / 36 2.9 /42

205/50 R 17 89H M+S RSC

2.6 / 38 3.1 / 45

225/40 R 18 92V M+S XL RSC

2.7 / 39 3.2 / 46

Front: 225/45R 17 91 W RSCRear: 245/40R 17 91 W RSC

2.5 / 36-

-3.0 / 44

Front: 225/40R 18 88 Y RSCRear: 245/35R 18 88 Y RSC

2.4 / 35-

-2.9 /42

Front: 225/35R 19 88 Y XLRSCRear: 245/30R 19 89 Y XLRSC

2.8 / 41-

-3.2 / 46

Front: 225/40 R18 88 Y StdRear: 245/35 R18 92 Y XL Std

2.4 / 35-

-2.9 /42

Emergencywheel:T 125/80 R 1799 M

Speed up to a max. of50 mph / 80 km/h4.2 / 60

M235i, M235i xDriveWithout high-speed tuning feature

Tire size Pressure specificationsin bar/PSI

Specifications inbar/PSI with coldtires

225/40 R 18 92 VM+S XL A/S RSC205/50 R 17 89 HM+S RSC225/45 R 17 91 HM+S RSC225/40 R 18 92 VM+S XL RSC

2.5 / 36 2.8 / 41

Front: 225/40 R18 88 Y StdRear: 245/35 R 1892 Y XL Std

2.3 / 33-

-2.6 / 38

Front: 225/40R 18 88 Y RSCRear: 245/35 R 1888 Y RSC

2.3 / 33-

-2.6 / 38

Front: 225/35R 19 88 Y XL RSCRear: 245/30 R 1989 Y XL RSC

2.6 / 38-

-2.9 /42

Emergencywheel:T 125/80 R 17 99M

Speed up to a max. of50 mph / 80 km/h4.2 / 60

With high-speed tuning feature

Seite 175

Wheels and tires Mobility

175Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Tire size Pressure specifications inbar/PSI

Specifications inbar/PSI with coldtires

205/50 R 17 89H M+S RSC225/45 R 17 91H M+S RSC

2.7 / 39 3.1 / 45

225/40 R 18 92V M+S XL RSC

2.8 / 41 3.2 / 46

Front: 225/40 R18 88 Y StdRear: 245/35 R18 92 Y XL Std

2.5 / 36-

-2.9 /42

Front: 225/40R 18 88 Y RSCRear: 245/35R 18 88 Y RSC

2.5 / 36-

-2.9 /42

Front: 225/35R 19 88 Y XLRSCRear: 245/30R 19 89 Y XLRSC

2.9 /42-

-3.2 / 46

Emergencywheel:T 125/80 R 1799 M

Speed up to a max. of50 mph / 80 km/h4.2 / 60

Tire identification marksTire size245/45 R 18 96 Y245: nominal width in mm45: aspect ratio in %R: radial tire code

18: rim diameter in inches96: load rating, not for ZR tiresY: speed rating, before the R on ZR tires

Speed letterQ = up to 100 mph, 160 km/hR = up to 106 mph, 170 km/hS = up to 112 mph, 180 km/hT = up to 118 mph, 190 km/hH = up to 131 mph, 210 km/hV = up to 150 mph, 240 km/hW = up to 167 mph, 270 km/hY = up to 186 mph, 300 km/h

Tire Identification NumberDOT code: DOT xxxx xxx 0115xxxx: manufacturer code for the tire brandxxx: tire size and tire design0115: tire ageTires with DOT codes meet the guidelines ofthe U.S. Department of Transportation.

Tire ageDOT … 0115: the tire was manufactured in the1st week of 2015.

RecommendationRegardless of wear and tear, replace tires atleast every 6 years.

Uniform Tire Quality GradingQuality grades can be found where applicableon the tire sidewall between tread shoulderand maximum section width.For example: Treadwear 200; Traction AA;Temperature A

DOT Quality GradesTreadwearTraction AA A B C

Seite 176

Mobility Wheels and tires

176Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Temperature A B CAll passenger car tires must conform to Fed‐eral Safety Requirements in addition to thesegrades.

TreadwearThe treadwear grade is a comparative ratingbased on the wear rate of the tire when testedunder controlled conditions on a specified gov‐ernment test course. For example, a tiregraded 150 would wear one and one-half, 1 g,times as well on the government course as atire graded 100. The relative performance oftires depends upon the actual conditions oftheir use, however, and may depart signifi‐cantly from the norm due to variations in driv‐ing habits, service practices and differences inroad characteristics and climate.

TractionThe traction grades, from highest to lowest,are AA, A, B, and C.Those grades represent the tire's ability tostop on wet pavement as measured undercontrolled conditions on specified governmenttest surfaces of asphalt and concrete. A tiremarked C may have poor traction performance.The traction grade assigned to this tire isbased on straight-ahead braking traction tests,and does not include acceleration, cornering,hydroplaning, or peak traction characteristics.

TemperatureThe temperature grades are A, the highest, B,and C, representing the tire's resistance to thegeneration of heat and its ability to dissipateheat when tested under controlled conditionson a specified indoor laboratory test wheel.Sustained high temperature can cause the ma‐terial of the tire to degenerate and reduce tirelife, and excessive temperature can lead tosudden tire failure. The grade C correspondsto a level of performance which all passengercar tires must meet under the Federal MotorVehicle Safety Standard No. 109. Grades Band

A represent higher levels of performance onthe laboratory test wheel than the minimum re‐quired by law.

Temperature grade for this tireThe temperature grade for this tire is es‐

tablished for a tire that is properly inflated andnot overloaded. Excessive speed, underinfla‐tion, or excessive loading, either separately orin combination, can cause heat buildup andpossible tire failure.If necessary, have the vehicle towed.◀

RSC – Run-flat tiresRun-flat tires, refer to page 180, are labeledwith a circular symbol containing the lettersRSC marked on the sidewall.

M+SWinter and all-season tires with better coldweather performance than summer tires.

Tire treadSummer tiresDo not drive with a tire tread depth of less than0.12 in/3 mm.There is an increased danger of hydroplaning ifthe tire tread depth is less than 0.12 in/3 mm.

Winter tiresDo not drive with a tire tread depth of less than0.16 in/4 mm.Below a tread depth of 0.16 in/4 mm, tires areless suitable for winter operation.

Seite 177

Wheels and tires Mobility

177Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Minimum tread depth

Wear indicators are distributed around thetire's circumference and have the legally re‐quired minimum height of 0.063 in/1.6 mm.

They are marked on the side of the tire withTWI, Tread Wear Indicator.

Tire damageGeneral informationInspect your tires often for damage, foreignobjects lodged in the tread, and tread wear.

HintsDriving over rough or damaged road surfaces,as well as debris, curbs and other obstaclescan cause serious damage to wheels, tires andsuspension parts. This is more likely to occurwith low-profile tires, which provide less cush‐ioning between the wheel and the road. Becareful to avoid road hazards and reduce yourspeed, especially if your vehicle is equippedwith low-profile tires.Indications of tire damage or other vehicle de‐fects:▷ Unusual vibrations while driving.▷ Unusual handling such as a strong ten‐

dency to pull to the left or right.Damage can, e. g., be caused by driving overcurbs, road damage, or similar things.

In case of tire damageIf there are indications of tire damage, re‐

duce your speed immediately and have therims and tires checked right away; otherwise,there is the increased risk of an accident.Drive carefully to the nearest service center. Ifnecessary, have the vehicle towed or trans‐ported there. Otherwise, tire damage can be‐come life threatening for vehicle occupantsand also other traffic.◀

Repair of tire damageFor safety reasons, the manufacturer of

your vehicle recommends that you do not havedamaged tires repaired; they should be re‐placed. Otherwise, damage can occur as a re‐sult.◀

Changing wheels and tiresMounting

Information on mounting tiresHave mounting and balancing performed

only by a service center.If work is not carried out properly, there is adanger of subsequent damage and relatedsafety hazards.◀

Wheel and tire combinationYou can ask the service center about the rightwheel/tire combination and wheel rim versionsfor the vehicle.Incorrect wheel and tire combinations impairthe function of a variety of systems such asABS or DSC.To maintain good handling and vehicle re‐sponse, use only tires with a single tread con‐figuration from a single manufacturer.Following tire damage, have the original wheeland tire combination remounted on the vehicleas soon as possible.

Seite 178

Mobility Wheels and tires

178Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Approved wheels and tiresYou should only use wheels and tires

that have been approved by the vehicle manu‐facturer for your vehicle type; otherwise, e.g.,despite having the same official size ratings,variations can lead to chassis contact and withit, the risk of severe accidentsThe manufacturer of your vehicle cannot eval‐uate non-approved wheels and tires to deter‐mine if they are suited for use, and thereforecannot guarantee the operating safety of thevehicle.◀

Recommended tire brands

For each tire size, the manufacturer of your ve‐hicle recommends certain tire brands. Thesecan be identified by a star on the tire sidewall.With proper use, these tires meet the higheststandards for safety and handling.

New tiresTire traction is not optimal due to manufactur‐ing circumstances when tires are brand-new;they achieve their full traction potential after abreak-in time.Drive conservatively for the first200 miles/300 km.

Retreaded tiresThe manufacturer of your vehicle does not rec‐ommend the use of retreaded tires.

Retreaded tiresPossibly substantial variations in the de‐

sign and age of the tire casing structures canlimit service life and have a negative impact onroad safety.◀

Winter tiresWinter tires are recommended for operating onwinter roads.Although so-called all-season M+S tires pro‐vide better winter traction than summer tires,they do not provide the same level of perform‐ance as winter tires.

Maximum speed of winter tiresIf the maximum speed of the vehicle is higherthan the permissible speed for the winter tires,then a respective symbol is displayed in yourfield of vision. You can obtain this sign from thetire specialist or from your service center.

Maximum speed for winter tiresDo not exceed the maximum speed for

the respective winter tires; otherwise, tire dam‐age and accidents can occur.◀

Run-flat tiresIf you are already using run-flat tires, for yourown safety you should replace them only withthe same kind. No spare tire is available in thecase of a flat tire. Your service center will beglad to advise you.

Rotating wheels between axlesDifferent wear patterns can occur on the frontand rear axles depending on individual drivingconditions. The tires can be rotated betweenthe axles to achieve even wear. Your servicecenter will be glad to advise you. After rotating,check the tire pressure and correct if needed.Rotating the tires is not permissible on vehi‐cles with different tire sizes or rim sizes on thefront and rear axles.

Seite 179

Wheels and tires Mobility

179Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

StorageStore wheels and tires in a cool, dry place withas little exposure to light as possible.Always protect tires against all contact with oil,grease and fuels.Do not exceed the maximum tire inflation pres‐sure indicated on the side wall of the tire.

Run-flat tiresLabel

RSC label on the tire sidewall.The wheels consist of tires that are self-sup‐porting, to a limited degree, and possibly spe‐cial rims.The support of the sidewall allows the tire toremain drivable to a restricted degree in theevent of a tire inflation pressure loss.

Follow the instructions for continued drivingwith a flat tire.

Changing run-flat tiresFor your own safety, only use run-flat tires. Nospare tire is available in the case of a flat tire.Your service center will be glad to advise you.

Mobility SystemThe conceptWith the Mobility System, minor tire damagecan be sealed quickly to enable continuedtravel. To accomplish this, sealant is pumped

into the tires, which seals the damage from theinside.The compressor can be used to check the tireinflation pressure.

Hints▷ Follow the instructions on using the Mobi‐

lity System found on the compressor andsealant container.

▷ Use of the Mobility System may be ineffec‐tive if the tire puncture measures approx.1/8 in/4 mm or more.

▷ Contact the nearest service center if thetire cannot be made drivable.

▷ If possible, do not remove foreign bodiesthat have penetrated the tire.

▷ Pull the speed limit sticker off the sealantcontainer and apply it to the steeringwheel.

▷ The use of a sealant can damage the TPMwheel electronics. In this case, have theelectronics checked at the next opportu‐nity and have them replaced if needed.

Enclosed areasDo not let the engine run in enclosed

areas, since breathing in exhaust fumes maylead to loss of consciousness and death. Theexhaust gases contain carbon monoxide, anodorless and colorless but highly toxic gas.◀

StorageThe Mobility System is located under thecargo floor panel.

Seite 180

Mobility Wheels and tires

180Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Sealing container

▷ Sealing container, arrow 1.▷ Filling hose, arrow 2.Observe use-by date on the sealant container.

Compressor

1 On/off reel2 Holder for bottle3 Reduce inflation pressure4 Inflation pressure dial5 Compressor6 Connector/cable for socket7 Connection hose — stowed in the bottom

of the compressor

Filling the tire with sealant1. Shake the sealing container.

2. Take the connection hose completely outof the compressor housing. Do not kink thehose.

3. Attach the connection hose to the connec‐tor of the sealing container, ensuring that itengages audibly.

Seite 181

Wheels and tires Mobility

181Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

4. Slide the sealing container upright into theholder on the compressor housing, ensur‐ing that it engages audibly.

5. Screw the connection hose onto the tirevalve of the defective wheel.

6. With the compressor switched off, insertthe plug into a power socket inside the ve‐hicle.

7. With the ignition turned on or the enginerunning, reel on the compressor.

Switch off the compressor after 10 mi‐nutes

Do not allow the compressor to run longer than10 minutes; otherwise, the device will overheatand may be damaged.◀

Let the compressor run for approx. 3 to 8 mi‐nutes to fill the tire with sealant and achieve atire inflation pressure of approx. 2.5 bar.While the tire is being filled with sealant, thetire inflation pressure may sporadically reachapprox. 5 bar. Do not reel off the compressor atthis point.If a tire inflation pressure of 2 bar is notreached:

1. Switch off the compressor.2. Unscrew the filling hose from the wheel.3. Drive 33 ft/10 m forward and back to dis‐

tribute the sealant in the tire.4. Inflate the tire again using the compressor.

If a tire inflation pressure of 2 bar cannot bereached, contact your service center.

Stowing the Mobility System1. Remove the connection hose of the seal‐

ant container from the wheel.2. Remove the connection hose from the

sealant container.

Seite 182

Mobility Wheels and tires

182Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

3. Wrap the empty sealant container and con‐nection hose in suitable material to avoiddirtying the cargo area.

4. Stow the Mobility System back in the vehi‐cle.

Distributing the sealantImmediately drive approx. 5 miles/10 km to en‐sure that the sealant is evenly distributed in thetire.Do not exceed a speed of 50 mph/80 km/h.If possible, do not drive at speeds less than12 mph/20 km/h.

To correct the tire inflation pressure1. Stop at a suitable location.2. Screw the connection hose onto the tire

valve stem.

3. Attach the connection hose directly to thecompressor.

4. Insert the connector into a power socketinside the vehicle.

5. Correct the tire inflation pressure to2.5 bar.▷ Increase pressure: with the ignition

turned on or the engine running, reelon the compressor.

▷ To reduce the pressure: press the but‐ton on the compressor.

Continuing the tripDo not exceed the maximum permissiblespeed of 50 mph/80 km/h.Reinitialize the Flat Tire Monitor.Reinitialize the Tire Pressure Monitor.Replace the defective tire and the sealant con‐tainer of the Mobility System as soon as possi‐ble.

Snow chainsFine-link snow chainsOnly certain types of fine-link snow chainshave been tested by the manufacturer of thevehicle, classified as road-safe and approved.Information about the approved snow chainsare available from the service center.

UseUse only in pairs on the rear wheels, equippedwith the tires of the following size:▷ 205/55 R 16.

Seite 183

Wheels and tires Mobility

183Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

▷ 205/50 R 17.▷ 225/45 R 17.Follow the snow chain manufacturer's instruc‐tions.Make sure that the snow chains are alwayssufficiently tight. Retighten as needed accord‐ing to the chain manufacturer's instructions.Do not initialize the Flat Tire Monitor aftermounting snow chains, as doing so may resultin incorrect readings.Do not initialize the Tire Pressure Monitor aftermounting snow chains, as doing so may resultin incorrect readings.When driving with snow chains, briefly activateDynamic Traction Control if needed.

Maximum speed with snow chainsDo not exceed a speed of 30 mph/50 km/hwhen using snow chains.

Seite 184

Mobility Wheels and tires

184Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Engine compartmentVehicle features and optionsThis chapter describes all standard, country-specific and optional features offered with theseries. It also describes features that are notnecessarily available in your car, e. g., due to

the selected options or country versions. Thisalso applies to safety-related functions andsystems. The respectively applicable countryprovisions must be observed when using therespective features and systems.

Important features in the engine compartment

1 Jump-starting, negative battery terminal2 Vehicle identification number3 Washer fluid reservoir4 Jump-starting, positive battery terminal5 Engine compartment fuse box

6 Oil filler neck7 Coolant reservoir

The coolant reservoir for 6-cylinder anddiesel engines is located on the oppositeside of the engine compartment.

Seite 185

Engine compartment Mobility

185Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

HoodHints

Working in the engine compartmentNever attempt to perform any service or

repair operations on your vehicle without thenecessary professional technical training.If you are unfamiliar with the statutory guide‐lines, have any work on the vehicle performedonly by a service center.If work is not carried out properly, there is adanger of subsequent damage and relatedsafety hazards.◀

Never reach into the engine compart‐ment

Never reach into spaces or gaps in the enginecompartment; otherwise, there is a risk of in‐jury, e.g., from rotating or hot parts.◀

Fold down wiper armBefore opening the hood, ensure that the

wiper arms are against the windshield, or thismay result in damage.◀

Opening the hood1. Pull lever, arrow 1.

Hood is unlocked

2. After the lever is released, pull the leveragain, arrow 2.Hood can be opened.

Indicator/warning lightsWhen the hood is unlocked, a Check Controlmessage is displayed.

Closing the hoodHood open when drivingIf you see any signs that the hood is not

completely closed while driving, pull over im‐mediately and close it securely.◀

Danger of jammingMake sure that the closing path of the

hood is clear; otherwise, injuries may result.◀

Let the hood drop from a height of approx. 16in/40 cm and push down on it to lock it fully.The hood must audibly engage on both sides.

Seite 186

Mobility Engine compartment

186Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Engine oilVehicle features and optionsThis chapter describes all standard, country-specific and optional features offered with theseries. It also describes features that are notnecessarily available in your car, e. g., due tothe selected options or country versions. Thisalso applies to safety-related functions andsystems. The respectively applicable countryprovisions must be observed when using therespective features and systems.

General informationThe engine oil consumption is dependent onthe driving style and driving conditions.The engine oil consumption can increase incase of, for example:▷ Sporty driving.▷ Break-in the engine.▷ Idling of the engine.▷ Usage of non-approved engine oil grades.Therefore, regularly check the engine oil levelafter refueling.The vehicle is equipped with electronic oilmeasurement.The electronic oil measurement has two meas‐uring principles:▷ Status display▷ Detailed measurement

Electronic oil measurementStatus display

The conceptThe engine oil level is monitored electronicallywhile driving and shown on the Control Dis‐play.

If the engine oil level reaches the minimumlevel, a check control message is displayed.

RequirementsA current measured value is available after ap‐prox. 30 minutes of driving. During a shortertrip, the status of the last, sufficiently long tripis displayed.With frequent short-distance trips, regularlyperform a detailed measurement.

Displaying the engine oil level1. "Vehicle info"2. "Vehicle status"3. "Engine oil level"

Engine oil level display messagesDifferent messages appear on the display de‐pending on the engine oil level. Pay attentionto these messages.If the engine oil level is too low, within the next125 miles/200 km Add engine oil, refer topage 188.

Engine oil level too lowAdd engine oil immediately; otherwise,

an insufficient amount of engine oil could re‐sult in engine damage.◀

Take care not to add too much engine oil.Too much engine oilHave the vehicle checked immediately;

otherwise, surplus engine oil can lead to en‐gine damage.◀

Detailed measurement

The conceptIn the detailed measurement the engine oillevel is checked and displayed via a scale.

Seite 187

Engine oil Mobility

187Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Gasoline engine:If the engine oil level reaches the minimumlevel, a check control message is displayed.Diesel engine:During the measurement, the idle speed is in‐creased somewhat.

General informationA detailed measurement is only possible withcertain engines.

Requirements▷ Vehicle is on level road.▷ Manual transmission: shift lever in neutral

position, clutch and accelerator pedals notdepressed.

▷ Steptronic transmission: selector lever inselector lever position N or P and accelera‐tor pedal not depressed.

▷ Engine is running and is at operating tem‐perature.

Performing a detailed measurementIn order to perform a detailed measurement ofthe engine oil level:

1. "Vehicle info"2. "Vehicle status"3. "Measure engine oil level"4. "Start measurement"The engine oil level is checked and displayedvia a scale.Time: approx. 1 minute.

Adding engine oilGeneral informationSwitch off the ignition and safely park the vehi‐cle before engine oil is added.

Oil filler neck

Only add engine oil when the message is dis‐played in the instrument cluster. The quantityto be added is indicated in the message dis‐played in the instrument cluster.

Adding engine oilAdd oil within the next 125 miles/200 km;

otherwise, this may cause engine damage.◀

Do not add too much engine oilWhen too much engine oil is added, im‐

mediately have the vehicle checked, otherwise,this may cause engine damage.◀

Protect childrenKeep oil, grease, etc., out of reach of chil‐

dren and observe the warnings on the contain‐ers to prevent health risks.◀

Engine oil types to addHints

No oil additivesOil additives may lead to engine dam‐

age.◀

Viscosity grades for engine oilsWhen selecting an engine oil, ensure that

the engine oil belongs to one of the viscositygrades SAE 0W-40, SAE 0W-30, SAE 5W-40,and SAE 5W-30 or malfunctions or enginedamage may occur.◀

Seite 188

Mobility Engine oil

188Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

The engine oil quality is critical for the life ofthe engine.

Suitable engine oil typesYou can add engine oils that meet the follow‐ing oil rating standards:

Gasoline engine

BMW Longlife-01.

BMW Longlife-01 FE.

Further information regarding the oil specifica‐tions and viscosities of engine oils can be in‐quired with the service center.

Alternative engine oil typesIf an engine oil suitable for continuous use isnot available, up to 1 US quart/liter of an en‐gine oil with the following oil rating can beadded:

Gasoline engine

API SM or superior oil rating.

Engine oil change:The vehicle manufacturer recommends thatyou let the service center change the motor oil.

Seite 189

Engine oil Mobility

189Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

CoolantVehicle features and optionsThis chapter describes all standard, country-specific and optional features offered with theseries. It also describes features that are notnecessarily available in your car, e. g., due tothe selected options or country versions. Thisalso applies to safety-related functions andsystems. The respectively applicable countryprovisions must be observed when using therespective features and systems.

HintsDanger of burns from hot engineDo not open the cooling system while

the engine is hot; otherwise, esliding coolantmay cause burns.◀

Suitable additivesOnly use suitable additives; otherwise,

engine damage may occur. The additives areharmful to your health.◀

Coolant consists of water and additives.Not all commercially available additives aresuitable for the vehicle. Information about thesuitable additives are available from the servicecenter.

Coolant levelGeneral informationDepending on the engine installation, the cool‐ant reservoir is located on the right side or theleft side of the engine compartment.

Checking1. Let the engine cool.2. The coolant level is correct if it lies be‐

tween the minimum and maximum marks.

The marks are on the side of the coolantreservoir.

Symbol Meaning

Maximum

Minimum

Adding1. Let the engine cool.2. Turn the lid of the coolant reservoir slightly

counterclockwise to allow any excesspressure to dissipate, then open it.

3. If the coolant is low, slowly add coolant upto the specified level; do not overfill.

4. Turn the lid until there is an audible click.The arrows on the coolant reservoir andthe lid must point towards one another.

5. Have the cause of the coolant loss elimi‐nated as soon as possible.

DisposalComply with the relevant environmen‐tal protection regulations when dispos‐ing of coolant and coolant additives.

Seite 190

Mobility Coolant

190Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

MaintenanceVehicle features and optionsThis chapter describes all standard, country-specific and optional features offered with theseries. It also describes features that are notnecessarily available in your car, e. g., due tothe selected options or country versions. Thisalso applies to safety-related functions andsystems. The respectively applicable countryprovisions must be observed when using therespective features and systems.

BMW maintenance systemThe maintenance system indicates requiredmaintenance measures, and thereby providessupport in maintaining road safety and the op‐erational reliability of the vehicle.In some cases scopes and intervals may varyaccording to the country-specific version. Re‐placement work, spare parts, fuels and lubri‐cants and wear materials are calculated sepa‐rately. Additional information is available fromthe service center.

Condition Based ServiceCBSSensors and special algorithms take into ac‐count the driving conditions of your vehicle.Based on this, Condition Based Service recog‐nizes the maintenance requirements.The system makes it possible to adapt theamount of maintenance corresponding to youruser profile.Detailed information on service requirements,refer to page 82, can be displayed on the Con‐trol Display.

Service data in the remote controlInformation on the required maintenance iscontinuously stored in the remote control.Your service center will read out this data andsuggest the right array of service proceduresfor your vehicle.Therefore, hand your service specialist the re‐mote control with which the vehicle was drivenmost recently.

Storage periodsStorage periods during which the vehicle bat‐tery was disconnected are not taken into ac‐count.If this occurs, have a service center update thetime-dependent maintenance procedures,such as checking brake fluid and, if needed,changing the engine oil and the microfilter/activated-charcoal filter.

Service and WarrantyInformation Booklet for USmodels and Warranty andService Guide Booklet forCanadian modelsPlease consult your Service and Warranty In‐formation Booklet for US models and Warrantyand Service Guide Booklet for Canadian mod‐els for additional information on service re‐quirements.Maintenance and repair should be performedby your service center. Make sure to have reg‐ular maintenance procedures recorded in thevehicle's Service and Warranty InformationBooklet for US models, and in the Warrantyand Service Guide Booklet for Canadian mod‐els. These entries are proof of regular mainte‐nance.

Seite 191

Maintenance Mobility

191Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Socket for OBD OnboardDiagnosisNote

Socket for Onboard DiagnosisThe socket for onboard diagnostics may

only be used by the service center or a work‐shop that operates in accordance with thespecifications of the vehicle manufacturer withcorrespondingly trained personnel and otherauthorized persons. Otherwise, use may resultin operating problems for the vehicle.◀

Position

There is an OBD socket on the driver's side forchecking the primary components in the vehi‐cle's emissions.

Emissions▷ The warning lamp lights up:

Emissions are deteriorating. Havethe vehicle checked as soon aspossible.

▷ The warning lamp flashes under certaincircumstances:This indicates that there is excessive mis‐firing in the engine.Reduce the vehicle speed and have thesystem checked immediately; otherwise,serious engine misfiring within a brief pe‐riod can seriously damage emission con‐trol components, in particular the catalyticconverter.

Seite 192

Mobility Maintenance

192Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Replacing componentsVehicle features and optionsThis chapter describes all standard, country-specific and optional features offered with theseries. It also describes features that are notnecessarily available in your car, e. g., due tothe selected options or country versions. Thisalso applies to safety-related functions andsystems. The respectively applicable countryprovisions must be observed when using therespective features and systems.

Onboard vehicle tool kit

The onboard vehicle tool kit is located underthe cargo floor panel.

Wiper blade replacementNote

Do not fold down the wipers withoutwiper blades

Do not fold down the wipers if wiper bladeshave not been installed; this may damage thewindshield.◀

Replacing the wiper blades1. To change the wiper blades, fold up, refer

to page 70, the wiper arms.2. Fold up and hold the wiper arm firmly.

3. Squeeze the retainer spring, arrow 1, andfold up the wiper blade, arrow 2.

4. Remove the wiper blade forward from thecatch.

5. Insert the new wiper blade in reverse orderof removal until it locks in place.

6. Fold down the wipers.Folding down wipers before opening thehood

Before opening the hood, ensure that thewiper arms with the wiper blades are againstthe windshield to prevent damage.◀

Lamp and bulb replacementHints

Lights and bulbsLights and bulbs make an essential contribu‐tion to vehicle safety.The manufacturer of the vehicle recommendsthat you entrust corresponding procedures tothe service center if you are unfamiliar those orif they have not been described here.You can obtain a selection of replacementbulbs at the service center.

Seite 193

Replacing components Mobility

193Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Danger of burnsOnly change bulbs when they are cool;

otherwise, there is a danger of gettingburned.◀

Working on the lighting systemWhen working on the lighting system,

you should always reel off the lights affected toprevent short circuits.To avoid possible injury or equipment damagewhen replacing bulbs, observe any instructionsprovided by the bulb manufacturer.◀

Do not perform work/bulb replacementon xenon headlights

Have any work on the xenon lighting system,including bulb replacement, performed only bya service center. Due to the high voltagepresent in the system, there is a danger of fatalinjuries if work is carried out improperly.◀

Do not touch the bulbsDo not touch the glass of new bulbs with

your bare hands, as even minute amounts ofcontamination will burn into the bulb's surfaceand reduce its service life.Use a clean tissue, cloth or something similar,or hold the bulb by its base.◀

Light-emitting diodes (LEDs)Some items of equipment use light-emittingdiodes installed behind a cover as a lightsource.These light-emitting diodes, which are relatedto conventional lasers, are officially designatedas Class 1 light-emitting diodes.

Do not remove the coversDo not remove the covers, and never

stare into the unfiltered light for several hours;otherwise, irritation of the retina could result.◀

Headlight glassCondensation can form on the inside of the ex‐ternal lights in cool or humid weather. Whendriving with the light switched on, the conden‐sation evaporates after a short time. The head‐light glass does not need to be changed.If the headlights do not dim despite drivingwith the light switched on, increasing humidityforms, e. g. water droplets in the light, have theservice center check this.

Headlight settingThe headlight adjustments can be affected bychanging lights and bulbs. Have the head‐lights' settings checked and corrected by serv‐ice after a replacement.

Front lights, bulb replacement

Halogen headlights

Overview

1 Daytime running lights/high beams/head‐light flasher

2 Parking lights3 Low beams4 Turn signal

Seite 194

Mobility Replacing components

194Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Accessing the turn signals and low beamsFollow general instructions, refer to page 193.

1. In the wheel house, loosen the two brack‐ets and remove the cover.

Turn signal21-watt bulb, PY21W

1. If necessary, pull the inside trim of thewheel house slightly inward. Turn the bulbsocket counterclockwise and remove.

2. Press the bulb gently into the socket, turncounterclockwise and remove.

3. Install the new bulb and bulb holder in re‐verse order of removal.

4. Attach the cover to the wheel house.

Low beams55-watt bulb, H7.

1. Turn the cover counterclockwise and re‐move.

2. Tilt the bulb down and then up to loosen itfrom the holder and remove.

3. Pull the connector off the bulb.4. Attach the connector to the new bulb.5. First insert the bulb at the top with the

strap, arrow 1, and then press down firmly,arrow 2. The bulb must audibly latch inplace.

6. Close the headlight housing with the lid.Make sure that the lid engages.

7. Attach the cover to the wheel house.

Seite 195

Replacing components Mobility

195Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Accessing the daytime running lights, highbeams/headlight flasher and parking lightsFollow general instructions, refer to page 193.

1. Open the hood, refer to page 186.2. Turn the cover counterclockwise and re‐

move.

Daytime running lights and high beams/headlight flasher55-watt bulb, H15.

1. Turn the bulb counterclockwise and re‐move.

2. Install the new bulb in reverse order of re‐moval. Turn the clockwise bulb here until ithits the stop.

3. Close the headlight housing with the lid.Make sure that the lid engages.

Parking lights6-watt bulb, H6W.

1. Tilt the bulb holder down and then up toloosen it from the holder and remove it.

2. Carefully remove the bulb from the bulbholder.

3. To insert the new bulb, proceed in reverseorder of removal. Make sure you hear thebulb holder engage.

4. Close the headlight housing with the lid.

Xenon headlights

HintsBecause of the long life of these bulbs, thelikelihood of failure is very low. Switching thelights on and off frequently shortens their life.If a bulb fails, reel on the front fog lights andcontinue the trip with great care. Comply withlocal regulations.

Do not perform work/bulb replacementon xenon headlights

Have any work on the xenon lighting system,including bulb replacement, performed only bya service center. Due to the high voltagepresent in the system, there is a danger of fatalinjuries if work is carried out improperly.◀

For checking and adjusting headlamp aim,please contact your BMW center.

Seite 196

Mobility Replacing components

196Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

At a glance

1 Parking lights / daytime running lights2 Low beams/high beams/headlight flasher3 Turn signal

Xenon headlightsLow beams and high beams are designed withxenon technology.The parking lights and daylight running lightsare made using LED technology.Contact your service center in the event of amalfunction.

Turn signalFollow general instructions, refer to page 193.

21-watt bulb, PY21W

1. In the wheel house, loosen the two brack‐ets and remove the cover.

2. If necessary, pull the inside trim of thewheel house slightly inward. Turn the bulbsocket counterclockwise and remove.

3. Press the bulb gently into the socket, turncounterclockwise and remove.

4. Install the new bulb and bulb holder in re‐verse order of removal.

5. Attach the cover to the wheel house.

Front fog lightsFollow general instructions, refer to page 193.35-watt bulb, H8.

1. Use the back side of the screwdriver fromthe onboard vehicle tool kit to remove thethree wheel house panel screws, arrow 1.

Seite 197

Replacing components Mobility

197Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Carefully raise the wheel house panel, ar‐row 2.

2. Pull off the bulb connector, arrow 1.Turn the bulb, arrow 2.Left side of vehicle: turn clockwise.Right side of vehicle: turn counterclock‐wise.Remove the bulb.

3. Insert the new bulb, connect the connectorand screw on the wheel house panel.

Turn signal in exterior mirrorThe turn signals in the exterior mirrors featureLED technology. Contact your service centerin the event of a malfunction.

Tail lights, bulb replacement

Overview

1 Turn signal2 Top brake lamp3 Reversing lamp4 Rear lamp5 Bottom brake lights

Bulb replacementFollow general instructions, refer to page 193.Turn signal, brake, tail, rear or reversing lamp:21-watt bulb, P21WRear fog lamp: 6-watt bulb, H6W.

Removing the tail lamp1. Open trunk lid.2. Open the two covers on the tail lamp.

3. With the handle of the screwdriver from theonboard vehicle tool kit, loosen and re‐move the nuts on the two fasteners. Makesure that the nuts do not drop into the

Seite 198

Mobility Replacing components

198Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

bumper area. In addition to the two outerfasteners, there is another inner fastener.

4. Grasp the handle with one hand, arrow 1,and brace with the free hand on the out‐side, arrow 2. Carefully pry out the taillamp, arrow 3, until the rubber mount re‐leases from the inner fastener.

5. Remove the plug from the bulb holder.

Replacing the bulbs1. Loosen the six fasteners on the tail lamp,

arrows 1, and remove the tail lamp from thelamp holder, arrow 2.

2. Press the defective bulb gently into thesocket, turn counterclockwise and remove.

3. Proceed in the reverse order to insert thenew bulb and attach the bulb holder to thetail lamp. Make sure that the bulb holderengages in all fasteners.

Installing the tail lamp1. Connect the plug to the bulb holder.2. Insert the tail lamp straight in and press it

in, arrow 1, until the rubber mount latchesin the inner fastener. Make sure when in‐serting the tail lamp that the rubber lip, ar‐row 2, on the top side of the tail lamp doesnot fold over. Screw on the two nuts, ar‐row 3, and close covers.

Central brake lamp and license platelampFollow general instructions, refer to page 193.These lights are made using LED technology.Contact your service center in the event of amalfunction.

Changing wheelsHintsWhen using run-flat tires or sealants, a tiredoes not need to be changed immediately inthe event of pressure loss due to a flat tire.Which is why no spare tire is available.The tools for changing wheels are available asaccessories from your service center.

Seite 199

Replacing components Mobility

199Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Jacking points for the vehicle jack

The jacking points for the vehicle jack are lo‐cated at the positions shown.

Vehicle batteryMaintenanceThe battery is maintenance-free.The added amount of acid is sufficient for theservice life of the battery.Further information about the battery can beobtained from your service center.

Battery replacementUse approved vehicle batteries onlyOnly use vehicle batteries that have been

approved for your vehicle by the manufacturer;otherwise, the vehicle could be damaged andsystems or functions may not be fully availa‐ble.◀

After a battery replacement, have the batteryregistered on the vehicle by the service centerto ensure that all comfort features are fullyavailable and that any Check Control mes‐sages of these comfort features are no longerdisplayed.

Charging the battery

General informationMake sure that the battery is always suffi‐ciently charged to guarantee that the batteryremains usable for its full service life.

The battery may need to be charged in the fol‐lowing cases:▷ When making frequent short-distance

drives.▷ If the vehicle is not used for prolonged pe‐

riods, longer than a month.

HintsDo not connect charging devices to the12 volt socket in the vehicle

Do not connect battery chargers to the fac‐tory-installed 12 volt sockets in the vehicle asthis may damage the vehicle battery due to anincreased power consumption.◀

Starting aid terminalsIn the vehicle, only charge the battery via thestarting aid terminals, refer to page 204, in theengine compartment with the engine off.

Power failureAfter a temporary power loss, some equipmentneeds to be newly initialized or individual set‐tings updated, e. g.:▷ Seat and mirror memory: store the posi‐

tions again.▷ Time: update.▷ Date: update.▷ Glass sunroof and sliding visor: initialize

the system, refer to page 47.

Disposing of old batteriesHave old batteries disposed of by yourservice center or bring them to a recy‐cling center.

Maintain the battery in an upright position fortransport and storage. Secure the battery sothat it does not tip over during transport.

Seite 200

Mobility Replacing components

200Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

FusesHints

Replacing fusesNever attempt to repair a blown fuse and

do not replace a defective fuse with a substi‐tute of another color or amperage rating; thiscould lead to a circuit overload, ultimately re‐sulting in a fire in the vehicle.◀

Plastic tweezers and information on the fusetypes and locations are stored in the fuse boxin the trunk.

In the engine compartment1. Use the onboard vehicle tool kit to loosen

the three cover screws, arrow 1.

2. Squeeze and raise the holder, arrow 2.3. Remove the cover from one side, arrow 3.4. Press the four fasteners and remove the

cover.

Attaching the covers1. When attaching the cover, make sure that

all four fasteners are engaged.

2. Attach the cover under the rubber lip andthen thread it between the bars.

3. Press down on the holder and tighten thethree screws.

In the trunk

Fold up the cargo floor panel.

Information on the fuse types and locations isfound on a separate sheet.

Seite 201

Replacing components Mobility

201Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Breakdown assistanceVehicle features and optionsThis chapter describes all standard, country-specific and optional features offered with theseries. It also describes features that are notnecessarily available in your car, e. g., due tothe selected options or country versions. Thisalso applies to safety-related functions andsystems. The respectively applicable countryprovisions must be observed when using therespective features and systems.

Hazard warning flashers

The button is located in the center console.

Intelligent EmergencyRequestThe conceptIn case of an emergency, an Emergency Re‐quest can be made through this system.

General informationOnly press the SOS button in an emergency.

HintsEmergency Request not guaranteedFor technical reasons, the Emergency

Request cannot be guaranteed under unfavor‐able conditions.◀

Overview

SOS button in the roofliner

Requirements▷ The SIM card integrated in the vehicle has

been activated.▷ The radio-ready state is switched on.▷ The Assist system is functional.

Initiating an Emergency Request1. Press the cover briefly to open it.2. Press the SOS button until the LED at the

button lights up green.▷ The LED lights up green: an Emergency

Request was initiated.If a cancel prompt appears on the display,the Emergency Request can be aborted.If the situation allows, wait in your vehicleuntil the voice connection has been estab‐lished.

▷ The LED flashes green when a connectionto the BMW Response Center has beenestablished.

Seite 202

Mobility Breakdown assistance

202Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

When the emergency request is receivedat the BMW Response Center, the BMWResponse Center contacts you and takesfurther steps to help you.Even if you are unable to respond, theBMW Response Center can take furthersteps to help you under certain circum‐stances.For this, data are transmitted to the BMWResponse Center which serve to deter‐mine the necessary rescue measures. E. g.the current position of the vehicle, if it canbe established.

▷ If the LED is flashing green, but the BMWResponse Center can no longer be heardvia the speaker, you can nevertheless stillbe heard at the BMW Response Center.

Initiating an Emergency RequestautomaticallyUnder certain conditions, an Emergency Re‐quest is automatically initiated immediately af‐ter a severe accident. Automatic Collision Noti‐fication is not affected by pressing the SOSbutton.

Warning triangle

The warning triangle is located on the inside ofthe trunk lid.To remove, loosen the bracket.

First aid kitNoteSome of the articles have a limited service life.Check the expiration dates of the contentsregularly and replace any expired itemspromptly.

Storage

The first aid kit is located in the trunk in thestorage compartment.

Jump-startingGeneral informationIf the battery is discharged, the engine can bestarted using the battery of another vehicleand two jumper cables. Only use jumper ca‐bles with fully insulated clamp handles.

HintsDo not touch live partsTo avoid the risk of potentially fatal in‐

jury, always avoid all contact with electricalcomponents while the engine is running.◀

To prevent personal injury or damage to bothvehicles, adhere strictly to the following proce‐dure.

Seite 203

Breakdown assistance Mobility

203Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

PreparationBodywork contact between vehiclesMake sure that there is no contact be‐

tween the bodywork of the two vehicles; other‐wise, there is a danger of short circuits.◀

1. Check whether the battery of the other ve‐hicle has a voltage of 12 volts. This infor‐mation can be found on the battery.

2. Switch off the engine of the assisting vehi‐cle.

3. Switch off any electronic systems/powerconsumers in both vehicles.

Starting aid terminalsConnecting orderConnect the jumper cables in the correct

order to prevent risk of injury from arcing.◀

The so-called starting aid terminal in the en‐gine compartment acts as the battery's posi‐tive terminal.Open the cover of the starting aid terminal.

The body ground or a special nut acts as thebattery negative terminal.

Connecting the cables1. Open the cover of the BMW starting aid

terminal.2. Attach one terminal clamp of the positive

jumper cable to the positive terminal of thebattery, or to the corresponding startingaid terminal of the vehicle providing assis‐tance.

3. Attach the terminal clamp on the other endof the cable to the positive terminal of thebattery, or to the corresponding startingaid terminal of the vehicle to be started.

4. Attach one terminal clamp of the negativejumper cable to the negative terminal ofthe battery, or to the corresponding engineor body ground of assisting vehicle.

5. Attach the second terminal clamp to thenegative terminal of the battery, or to thecorresponding engine or body ground ofthe vehicle to be started.

Starting the engineNever use spray fluids to start the engine.

1. Start the engine of the assisting vehicleand let it run for several minutes at an in‐creased idle speed.

2. Start the engine of the vehicle that is to bestarted in the usual way.If the first starting attempt is not success‐ful, wait a few minutes before making an‐other attempt in order to allow the dis‐charged battery to recharge.

3. Let both engines run for several minutes.4. Disconnect the jumper cables in the re‐

verse order.Check the battery and recharge if needed.

Seite 204

Mobility Breakdown assistance

204Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Tow-starting and towingNote

Tow-starting and towingFor tow-starting or towing, switch off the

Intelligent Safety systems; otherwise malfunc‐tions of the individual braking systems mightlead to accidents.◀

Manual transmissionGearshift lever in neutral position.

TowingFollow the towing instructionsFollow all towing instructions; otherwise,

vehicle damage or accidents may occur.◀

▷ Make sure that the ignition is switched on;otherwise, the low beams, tail lights, turnsignals, and wipers may be unavailable.

▷ Do not tow the vehicle with the rear axletilted, as the front wheels could turn.

▷ When the engine is stopped, there is nopower assist. Consequently, more forceneeds to be applied when braking andsteering.

▷ Larger steering wheel movements are re‐quired.

▷ The towing vehicle must not be lighterthan the vehicle being towed; otherwise,it will not be possible to control the vehi‐cle's response.

Tow truck

With rear-wheel drive

Your vehicle should be transported with a towtruck with a so-called lift bar or on a flat bed.

Do not lift the vehicleDo not lift the vehicle by the tow fitting or

body and chassis parts; otherwise, damagemay result.◀

With xDrive

The vehicle should only be transported on aloading platform.

Do not tow with only the front or rear axleraised

Do not tow the BMW with just the front or rearaxle raised; otherwise, the wheels could lockup and the transfer case could be damaged.◀

Do not lift the vehicleDo not lift the vehicle by the tow fitting or

body and chassis parts; otherwise, damagemay result.◀

Seite 205

Breakdown assistance Mobility

205Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Steptronic transmission: transportingyour vehicle

NoteYour vehicle is not permitted to be towed.Therefore, contact a service center in theevent of a breakdown.

Do not have the vehicle towedHave your vehicle transported on a load‐

ing platform only; otherwise, damage may oc‐cur.◀

Tow truck

The vehicle should only be transported on aloading platform.

Do not lift the vehicleDo not lift the vehicle by the tow fitting or

body and chassis parts; otherwise, damagemay result.◀

Use tow fitting located in the front only for po‐sitioning the vehicle.

Towing other vehicles

HintsLight towing vehicleThe towing vehicle must not be lighter

than the vehicle being towed; otherwise, it willnot be possible to control the vehicle's re‐sponse.◀

Attaching the tow bar/tow rope correctlyAttach the tow bar or tow rope to the tow

fitting; connecting it to other vehicle parts maycause damage.◀

▷ Switch on the hazard warning system, de‐pending on local regulations.

▷ If the electrical system has failed, clearlyidentify the vehicle being towed by placinga sign or a warning triangle in the rear win‐dow.

Tow barThe tow fittings used should be on the sameside on both vehicles.Should it prove impossible to avoid mountingthe tow bar at an offset angle, please observethe following:▷ Maneuvering capability is limited going

around corners.▷ The tow bar will generate lateral forces if it

is secured with an offset.

Tow ropeWhen starting to tow the vehicle, make surethat the tow rope is taut.To avoid jerking and the associated stresseson the vehicle components when towing, al‐ways use nylon ropes or nylon straps.

Tow fittingThe screw-in tow fitting should always be car‐ried in the vehicle.The tow fitting can be screwed in at the frontor rear of the BMW.

Seite 206

Mobility Breakdown assistance

206Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

The tow fitting is located in the onboard vehi‐cle tool kit under the cargo floor panel.

Tow fitting, information on use▷ Use only the tow fitting provided with

the vehicle and screw it all the way in.▷ Use the tow fitting for towing on paved

roads only.▷ Avoid lateral loading of the tow fitting, e.g.,

do not lift the vehicle by the tow fitting.Otherwise, damage to the tow fitting and thevehicle can occur.◀

Screw thread for tow fitting

Press on the mark on the edge of the cover topush it out.

Tow-starting

Steptronic transmissionDo not tow-start the vehicle.Tow-starting the engine is not possible due tothe Steptronic transmission.Have the cause of the starting problems fixed.

Manual transmissionIf possible, do not tow-start the vehicle butstart the engine by jump-starting, refer topage 203. If the vehicle is equipped with a cat‐alytic converter, only tow-start while the en‐gine is cold.

1. Switch on the hazard warning system andcomply with local regulations.

2. Ignition, refer to page 63, on.3. Engage third gear.4. Have the vehicle tow-started with the

clutch pedal pressed and slowly releasethe pedal. After the engine starts, immedi‐ately press on the clutch pedal again.

5. Stop at a suitable location, remove the towbar or rope, and switch off the hazardwarning system.

6. Have the vehicle checked.

Seite 207

Breakdown assistance Mobility

207Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

CareVehicle features and optionsThis chapter describes all standard, country-specific and optional features offered with theseries. It also describes features that are notnecessarily available in your car, e. g., due tothe selected options or country versions. Thisalso applies to safety-related functions andsystems. The respectively applicable countryprovisions must be observed when using therespective features and systems.

Car washesGeneral informationRegularly remove foreign objects such asleaves in the area below the windshield whenthe hood is raised.Wash your vehicle frequently, particularly inwinter. Intense soiling and road salt can dam‐age the vehicle.

HintsSteam jets or high-pressure washersWhen using steam jets or high-pressure

washers, hold them a sufficient distance awayand use a maximum temperature of140 ℉/60 ℃.If the vehicle has a glass sunroof, ensure that adistance of at least 31.5 inches/80 cm is main‐tained. Holding them too close or using exces‐sively high pressures or temperatures cancause damage or preliminary damage that maythen lead to long-term damage.Follow the user's manual for the high-pressurewasher.◀

Cleaning sensors/camera lenses withhigh-pressure washers

When using high-pressure washers, do notspray the sensors and camera lenses on theoutside of the vehicle for long periods andmaintain a distance of at least 12 in/30 cm.◀

Automatic car washes

HintsDo not use high pressure washing sys‐tems

With washing systems operating at high pres‐sures and nozzle positions close to the win‐dows, drops of water can penetrate.◀

▷ Give preference to cloth car washes orthose that use soft brushes in order toavoid paint damage.

▷ Make sure that the wheels and tires are notdamaged by the transport mechanisms.

▷ Fold in the exterior mirrors; otherwise, theymay be damaged, depending on the widthof the vehicle.

▷ Deactivate the rain sensor, refer topage 69, to avoid unintentional wiper acti‐vation.

▷ In some cases, an unintentional alarm canbe triggered by the interior motion sensorof the alarm system. Follow the instruc‐tions on avoiding an unintentional alarm,refer to page 45.

Guide rails in car washesAvoid car washes with guide rails higher

than 4 in/10 cm; otherwise, the vehicle bodycould be damaged.◀

Before driving into a car washIn order to ensure that the vehicle can roll in acar wash, take the following steps:

Seite 208

Mobility Care

208Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Manual transmission:

1. Drive into the car wash.2. Shift to neutral.3. Switch the engine off.4. Switch on the ignition.Steptronic transmission:

1. Drive into the car wash.2. Engage selector lever position N.3. Switch the engine off.

In this way, the ignition remains switchedon, and a Check-Control message is dis‐played.

Do not turn off the ignition in the carwash

Do not turn off the ignition in the car wash;otherwise, selector lever position P is en‐gaged and damages can result.◀

The vehicle cannot be locked from the outsidewhen in selector lever position N. A signalsounds when an attempt is made to lock thevehicle.To start the engine with manual transmission:

1. Press on the clutch pedal.2. Press the Start/Stop button.To start the engine with Steptronic transmis‐sion:

1. Depress the brake pedal.2. Press the Start/Stop button.Pressing the Start/Stop button without step‐ping on the brake turns the ignition off.

Selector lever positionSelector lever position P is engaged automati‐cally:▷ When the ignition is switched off.▷ After approx. 15 minutes.

Headlights▷ Do not rub dry and do not use abrasive or

acidic cleansers.▷ Soak areas that have been dirtied e. g.,

from insects, with shampoo and wash offwith water.

▷ Thaw ice with de-icing spray; do not use anice scraper.

After washing the vehicleAfter washing the vehicle, apply the brakesbriefly to dry them; otherwise, braking actioncan be reduced and corrosion of the brakediscs can occur.Completely remove all residues on the win‐dows, to minimize loss of visibility due tosmearing and to reduce wiper noises andwiper blade wear.

Vehicle careCar care productsBMW recommends using care and cleaningproducts from BMW, since these have beentested and approved.

Car care and cleaning productsFollow the instructions on the container.

When cleaning the interior, open the doors orwindows.Only use products intended for cleaning vehi‐cles.Cleansers can contain substances that aredangerous and harmful to your health.◀

Vehicle paintRegular care contributes to driving safety andvalue retention. Environmental influences inareas with elevated air pollution or natural con‐taminants, such as tree resin or pollen can af‐fect the vehicle's paintwork. Tailor the fre‐quency and extent of your car care to theseinfluences.

Seite 209

Care Mobility

209Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Aggressive substances such as spilled fuel, oil,grease or bird droppings, must be removed im‐mediately to prevent the finish from being al‐tered or discolored.

Leather careRemove dust from the leather often, using acloth or vacuum cleaner.Otherwise, particles of dust and road grimechafe in pores and folds, and lead to increasedwear and premature degradation of the leathersurface.To guard against discoloration, such as fromclothing, provide leather care roughly everytwo months.Clean light-colored leather more frequently be‐cause soiling on such surfaces is substantiallymore visible.Use leather care products; otherwise, dirt andgrease will gradually break down the protectivelayer of the leather surface.Suitable care products are available from theservice center.

Upholstery material careVacuum regularly with a vacuum cleaner.If upholstery is very dirty, e.g., with beveragestains, use a soft sponge or microfiber clothwith a suitable interior cleaner.Clean the upholstery down to the seams usinglarge sweeping motions. Avoid rubbing thematerial vigorously.

Damage from Velcro® fastenersOpen Velcro® fasteners on pants or

other articles of clothing can damage the seatcovers. Ensure that any Velcro® fasteners areclosed.◀

Caring for special components

Light-alloy wheelsWhen cleaning the vehicle, use only neutralwheel cleaners having a pH value from 5 to 9.

Do not use abrasive cleaning agents or steamjets above 140 ℉/60 ℃. Follow the manufac‐turer's instructions.Aggressive, acidic or alkaline cleaning agentscan destroy the protective layer of adjacentcomponents, such as the brake disk.

Chrome surfacesCarefully clean components such as the radia‐tor grille or door handles with an ample supplyof water, possibly with shampoo added, partic‐ularly when they have been exposed to roadsalt.

Rubber componentsAside from water, treat only with rubbercleansers.When cleaning rubber seals, do not use anysilicon-containing car care products in order toavoid damage or noises.

Fine wood partsClean fine wood facing and fine wood compo‐nents only with a moist rag. Then dry with asoft cloth.

Plastic componentsThese include:▷ Imitation leather surfaces.▷ Roofliner.▷ Lamp lenses.▷ Instrument cluster cover.▷ Matt black spray-coated components.▷ Painted parts in the interior.Clean with a microfiber cloth.Dampen cloth lightly with water.Do not soak the roofliner.

No cleansers that contain alcohol or sol‐vents

Do not use cleansers that contain alcohol orsolvents, such as lacquer thinners, heavy-duty

Seite 210

Mobility Care

210Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

grease removers, fuel, or such; this could leadto surface damage.◀

Safety beltsDirty belt straps impede the reeling action andthus have a negative impact on safety.

Chemical cleaningDo not clean chemically; this can destroy

the webbing.◀

Use only a mild soapy solution, with the safetybelts clipped into their buckles.Do not allow the reels to retract the safetybelts until they are dry.

Carpets and floor matsNo objects in the area around the pedalsKeep floor mats, carpets, and any other

objects out of the pedal area; otherwise, thefunction of the pedals could be impeded whiledriving and create the risk of an accident.Do not place additional floor mats over existingmats or other objects.Only use floor mats that have been approvedfor the vehicle and can be properly attached tofloor.Ensure that the floor mats are securely fas‐tened again after they were removed for clean‐ing, e.g.◀

Floor mats can be removed from the car's inte‐rior for cleaning.If the floor carpets are very dirty, clean with amicrofiber cloth and water or a textile cleaner.To prevent matting of the carpet, rub back andforth in the direction of travel only.

Sensor/camera lensesTo clean sensors and camera lenses, use acloth moistened with a small amount of glassdetergent.

Displays/monitorsCleaning displays and screensDo not use any chemical or household

cleaning agents; otherwise, surfaces can be af‐fected.◀

Keeping out moistureKeep all fluids and moisture away from

the unit; otherwise, electrical components canbe damaged.◀

Avoid pressureAvoid pressing too hard when cleaning

and do not use abrasive materials; otherwise,damage can result.◀

Clean with a clean, antistatic microfiber cloth.

Long-termWhen the vehicle is shut down for longer thanthree months, special measures must betaken. Additional information is available fromthe service center.

Seite 211

Care Mobility

211Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

ReferenceThis chapter contains the technical data and an

index that will quickly take you to the informationyou need.

Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Technical dataVehicle features and optionsThis chapter describes all standard, country-specific and optional features offered with theseries. It also describes features that are notnecessarily available in your car, e. g., due to

the selected options or country versions. Thisalso applies to safety-related functions andsystems. The respectively applicable countryprovisions must be observed when using therespective features and systems.

NoteThe technical data and specifications in thisOwner's Manual are used as guidance values.The vehicle-specific data can deviate from this,for example, due to the selected special equip‐ment, country version or country-specificmeasurement method. Detailed values can be

found in the approval documents, on informa‐tion signs on the vehicle or can be obtainedfrom the service center.The information in the vehicle documents al‐ways has priority.

DimensionsThe dimensions can vary depending on themodel version, equipment or country-specificmeasurement method.The specified heights do not take into accountattached parts, for example, a roof antenna,

roof racks or spoiler. The heights can deviate,for example, due to the selected special equip‐ment, tires, load and chassis version.

2 Series

Width with mirrors inches/mm 78.1/1,984

Width without mirrors inches/mm 69.8/1,774

Height inches/mm 55.4/1,408–55.8/1,418

Length inches/mm 174.7/4,437–175.9/4,469

Wheelbase inches/mm 105.9/2,690

Smallest turning radius diam. ft/m 35.8/10.9–37.1/11.3

WeightsThe values preceding the slash apply to vehi‐cles with manual transmission; the values fol‐

lowing the slash apply to vehicles with Step‐tronic transmission.

Seite 214

Reference Technical data

214Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Seite 215

Technical data Reference

215Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

228i

Approved gross vehicle weight lbskg

4,165/4,210–4,2201,889/1,910–1,914

Load lbs/kg 785/356

Approved front axle load lbs

Approved rear axle load lbs/kg 2,345/1,064

Approved roof load capacity lbs/kg 165/75

Cargo area capacity cu ft/l 13.8/390

M235i powered by BMW M

Approved gross vehicle weight lbskg

4,330/4,3651,964/1,980

Load lbs/kg 810/367

Approved front axle load lbs/kg 2,135/968

Approved rear axle load lbs/kg 2,380/1,080

Approved roof load capacity lbs/kg 165/75

Cargo area capacity cu ft/l 13.8/390

228i xDrive

Approved gross vehicle weight lbskg

4,360–4,3701,978–1,982

Load lbs/kg 785/356

Approved front axle load lbs 2,050–2,100

Approved rear axle load lbs/kg 2,405/1,091

Approved roof load capacity lbs/kg 165/75

Cargo area capacity cu ft/l 13.8/390

1,985/1,985–1,995900/900–905kg

kg 930–953

Information Provided by:

M235i xperformanceed by BMW M

Approved gross vehicle weight lbskg

4,4902,037

Load lbs/kg 785/356

Approved front axle load lbs/kg 2,245/1,018

Approved rear axle load lbs/kg 2,380/1,080

Approved roof load capacity lbs/kg 165/75

Cargo area capacity cu ft/l 13.8/390

Capacities

US gal/liters Notes

Fuel tank, approx. 13.7/52 Fuel quality, refer topage 170

Seite 216

Reference Technical data

216Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Seite 217

Technical data Reference

217Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Everything from A to ZIndexAABS, Antilock Brake Sys‐

tem 112 Acceleration Assistant, refer

to Launch Control 74 Accessories and parts 7 Activated-charcoal filter 135 Adaptive brake lights, refer to

Brake force display 111 Adaptive Light Control 91 Additives, oil 188 Adjustments, seats/head re‐

straints 48 After washing vehicle 209 Airbags 95 Airbags, indicator/warning

light 96 Air circulation, refer to Recir‐

culated-air mode 131, 134 Air, dehumidifying, refer to

Cooling function 131, 134 Air distribution,

manual 131, 134 Air flow, air conditioner 131 Air flow, automatic climate

control 134 Air pressure, tires 172 Air vents, refer to Ventila‐

tion 135 Alarm system 44 Alarm, unintentional 45 All around the center con‐

sole 16 All around the roofliner 17 All around the steering

wheel 14 All-season tires, refer to Win‐

ter tires 179 All-wheel-drive 113

Alternating-code hand-heldtransmitter 138

Alternative oil types 189 Ambient light 94 Antifreeze, washer fluid 70 Antilock Brake System,

ABS 112 Anti-slip control, refer to

DSC 112 Approved axle load 214 Approved engine oils, see

Suitable engine oiltypes 189

Arrival time 86 Ash tray 141 Assistance when driving

off 116 Attentiveness assistant 111 AUTO intensity 133 Automatic car wash 208 Automatic climate con‐

trol 130 Automatic climate control

with enhanced features 132 Automatic Curb Monitor 56 Automatic deactivation, front-

seat passenger airbags 97 Automatic headlight con‐

trol 91 Automatic locking 43 Automatic recirculated-air

control 134 Automatic transmission, see

Steptronic transmission 71 AUTO program, automatic cli‐

mate control 133 AUTO program, climate con‐

trol 131 AUTO program, intensity 133 Auto Start/Stop function 65 Average fuel consumption 86

Average speed 86 Axle loads, weights 214

BBackrest curvature, refer to

Lumbar support 50 Backrest, width 50 Band-aids, refer to First aid

kit 203 Bar for tow-starting/

towing 206 Battery replacement, vehicle

battery 200 Battery replacement, vehicle

remote control 35 Battery, vehicle 200 Belts, safety belts 52 Beverage holder, cu‐

pholder 147 BMW Assist, see user's

manual for Navigation, En‐tertainment and Communi‐cation

BMW Driver’s Guide App 6 BMW Homepage 6 BMW Internet page 6 BMW maintenance sys‐

tem 191 Bonus range, ECO PRO 160 Bottle holder, refer to Cu‐

pholder 147 Brake assistant 112 Brake discs, break-in 152 Brake force display 111 Brake lights, adaptive 111 Brake lights, brake force dis‐

play 111 Brake pads, break-in 152 Braking, hints 153 Breakdown assistance 202

Seite 218

Reference Everything from A to Z

218Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Break-in 152 Brightness of Control Dis‐

play 88 Bulb replacement 193 Bulb replacement, front 194 Bulb replacement, rear 198 Bulbs and lights 193 Button, Start/Stop 63 Bypassing, refer to Jump-

starting 203

CCalifornia Proposition 65

Warning 7 Camera lenses, care 211 Camera, rearview cam‐

era 123 Can holder, refer to Cu‐

pholder 147 Car battery 200 Car care products 209 Care, displays 211 Care, vehicle 209 Cargo 155 Cargo area, enlarging 143 Cargo area, storage compart‐

ments 147 Cargo, securing 156 Cargo straps, securing

cargo 156 Car key, refer to Remote con‐

trol 34 Carpet, care 211 Car wash 208 Catalytic converter, refer to

Hot exhaust system 153 CBS Condition Based Serv‐

ice 191 CD/Multimedia, see user's

manual for Navigation, En‐tertainment and Communi‐cation

Center armrest 146 Center console 16 Central locking system 39

Central screen, refer to Con‐trol Display 18

Changes, technical, refer toSafety 7

Changing parts 193 Changing wheels 199 Changing wheels/tires 178 Chassis number, see vehicle

identification number 9 Check Control 77 Checking the oil level elec‐

tronically 187 Children, seating position 59 Children, transporting

safely 59 Child restraint fixing sys‐

tem 59 Child restraint fixing system

LATCH 61 Child restraint fixing systems,

mounting 59 Child seat, mounting 59 Child seats 59 Chrome parts, care 210 Cigarette lighter 141 Cleaning displays 211 Climate control 130, 132 Clock 81 Closing/opening via door

lock 39 Closing/opening with remote

control 37 Clothes hooks 147 Coasting 162 Coasting with engine decou‐

pled, coasting 162 Coasting with idling en‐

gine 162 Cockpit 14 Combination reel, refer to

Turn signals 67 Combination switch, refer to

Wiper system 68 Comfort Access 41 COMFORT program, Dy‐

namic Driving Control 116

Compartments in thedoors 146

Compass 139 Compressor 180 Condensation on win‐

dows 135 Condensation under the vehi‐

cle 154 Condition Based Service

CBS 191 Configuring driving pro‐

gram 116 Confirmation signal 43 ConnectedDrive, see user's

manual for Navigation, En‐tertainment and Communi‐cation

ConnectedDrive Services Connecting electrical devi‐

ces 141 Continued driving with a flat

tire 100, 103 Control Display 18 Control Display, settings 87 Controller 18, 19 Control systems, driving sta‐

bility 112 Convenient opening with the

remote control 37 Coolant 190 Coolant level 190 Coolant temperature 80 Cooling function 131, 134 Cooling, maximum 133 Cooling system 190 Cornering light 91 Corrosion on brake discs 154 Cosmetic mirror 141 Courtesy lamps during un‐

locking 37 Courtesy lamps with the vehi‐

cle locked 38 Cruise control 118 Cruising range 81 Cupholder 147 Current fuel consumption 81

Seite 219

Everything from A to Z Reference

219Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

DDamage, tires 178 Damping control, dy‐

namic 114 Data, technical 214 Date 81 Daytime running lights 91 Daytime running lights, bulb

replacement 196 Defrosting, refer to defrosting

the windows 131 Defrosting, refer to Windows,

defrosting 135 Defrosting the windows 131 Dehumidifying, air 131, 134 Deleting personal data 25 Deletion of personal data 25 Destination distance 86 Digital clock 81 Digital compass 139 Dimensions 214 Dimmable exterior mirrors 57 Dimmable interior rearview

mirror 57 Direction indicator, refer to

Turn signals 67 Display, electronic, instru‐

ment cluster 76 Display lighting, refer to In‐

strument lighting 93 Displays, cleaning 211 Disposal, coolant 190 Disposal, vehicle battery 200 Distance control, refer to

PDC 120 Distance to destination 86 Divided screen view, split

screen 23 Door lock 39 Door lock, refer to Remote

control 34 Drive-off assistant 116 Drive-off assistant, refer to

DSC 112

Driver assistance, refer to In‐telligent Safety 103

Driving Assistant, refer to In‐telligent Safety 103

Driving Dynamics Con‐trol 114

Driving instructions, break-in 152

Driving mode 114 Driving notes, general 152 Driving stability control sys‐

tems 112 Driving style analysis 163 Driving tips 152 DSC Dynamic Stability Con‐

trol 112 DTC Dynamic Traction Con‐

trol 113 Dynamic Damping Con‐

trol 114 Dynamic Stability Control

DSC 112 Dynamic Traction Control

DTC 113

EECO PRO 159 ECO PRO, bonus range 160 ECO PRO display 159 ECO PRO driving mode 159 ECO PRO driving style analy‐

sis 163 ECO PRO mode 159 ECO PRO Tip - driving in‐

struction 161 EfficientDynamics 162 Electronic displays, instru‐

ment cluster 76 Electronic oil measure‐

ment 187 Electronic Stability Program

ESP, refer to DSC 112 Emergency detection, remote

control 35

Emergency release, fuel fillerflap 168

Emergency Request 202 Emergency start function, en‐

gine start 35 Emergency unlocking, trans‐

mission lock 74 Emergency unlocking, trunk

lid 41 Energy Control 81 Energy recovery 82 Engine, automatic Start/Stop

function 65 Engine, automatic switch-

off 65 Engine compartment 185 Engine compartment, work‐

ing in 186 Engine coolant 190 Engine idling when driving,

coasting 162 Engine oil 187 Engine oil, adding 188 Engine oil additives 188 Engine oil change 189 Engine oil filler neck 188 Engine oil types, alterna‐

tive 189 Engine oil types, ap‐

proved 189 Engine start during malfunc‐

tion 35 Engine start, jump-start‐

ing 203 Engine start, refer to Starting

the engine 64 Engine stop 64 Entering a car wash 208 Equipment, interior 137 Error displays, see Check

Control 77 ESP Electronic Stability Pro‐

gram, refer to DSC 112 Exchanging wheels/tires 178 Exhaust system 153

Seite 220

Reference Everything from A to Z

220Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Exterior mirror, automaticdimming feature 57

Exterior mirrors 55 External start 203 External temperature dis‐

play 81 External temperature warn‐

ing 81 Eyes for securing cargo 156

FFailure message, see Check

Control 77 False alarm, refer to Uninten‐

tional alarm 45 Fan, refer to Air

flow 131, 134 Filler neck for engine oil 188 Fine wood, care 210 First aid kit 203 Fitting for towing, see Tow fit‐

ting 206 Flat tire, changing

wheels 199 Flat Tire Monitor FTM 102 Flat tire, Tire Pressure Moni‐

tor TPM 98 Flat tire, warning

lamp 99, 102 Flooding 153 Floor carpet, care 211 Floor mats, care 211 Fogged up windows 131 Fold down the rear seat back‐

rest, see Though-loadingsystem 143

Fold-out position, wiper 70 Foot brake 153 Front airbags 95 Front-end collision warning

with City Braking func‐tion 104

Front fog lights 93 Front fog lights, front, bulb re‐

placement 197

Front lights 194 front-seat passenger airbags,

automatic deactivation 97 Front-seat passenger airbags,

indicator lamp 97 FTM Flat Tire Monitor 102 Fuel 170 Fuel consumption, refer to

Average fuel consump‐tion 86

Fuel filler flap 168 Fuel gauge 80 Fuel lid 168 Fuel quality 170 Fuel recommendation 170 Fuel, tank capacity 216 Fuse 201

GGarage door opener, refer to

Universal Integrated RemoteControl 137

Gasoline 170 Gear change, Steptronic

transmission 72 Gear shift indicator 83 General driving notes 152 Glare shield 141 Glass sunroof, powered 46 Glove compartment 145 Gross vehicle weight, ap‐

proved 214

HHalogen headlights, bulb re‐

placement 194 Handbrake, refer to parking

brake 67 Hand-held transmitter, alter‐

nating code 138 Hazard warning flashers 202 Head airbags 95 Headlight control, auto‐

matic 91

Headlight courtesy delay fea‐ture 91

Headlight flasher 68 Headlight flasher, bulb re‐

placement 196 Headlight glass 194 Headlights 194 Headlights, care 209 Headlight washer system 68 Head restraints 48 Head restraints, front 53 Head restraints, rear 54 Heavy cargo, stowing 156 High-beam Assistant 92 High beams 68 High beams/low beams, refer

to High-beam Assistant 92 High beams, bulb replace‐

ment 196 Hills 154 Hill start assistant, refer to

Drive-off assistant 116 Hints 6 Holder for beverages 147 Homepage 6 Hood 186 Horn 14 Hotel function, trunk lid 41 Hot exhaust system 153 Hydroplaning 153

IIce warning, see External

temperature warning 81 Icy roads, see External tem‐

perature warning 81 Identification marks, tires 176 Identification number, see ve‐

hicle identification num‐ber 9

iDrive 18 Ignition key, refer to Remote

control 34 Ignition off 63 Ignition on 63

Seite 221

Everything from A to Z Reference

221Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Indication of a flat tire 99, 102 Indicator and alarm lamps,

see Check Control 77 Indicator lamp, see Check

Control 77 Individual air distribu‐

tion 131, 134 Individual settings, refer to

Personal Profile 35 Inflation pressure, tires 172 Inflation pressure warning,

tires 102 Info display, refer to On-

Board computer 85 Initialize, Tire Pressure Moni‐

tor TPM 99 Initializing, Flat Tire Monitor

FTM 102 Instrument cluster 76 Instrument cluster, electronic

displays 76 Instrument lighting 93 Integrated key 34 Integrated Owner's Manual in

the vehicle 30 Intelligent Emergency Re‐

quest 202 Intelligent Safety 103 Intensity, AUTO pro‐

gram 133 Interior equipment 137 Interior lights 93 Interior lights during unlock‐

ing 37 Interior lights with the vehicle

locked 38 Interior motion sensor 45 Interior rearview mirror, auto‐

matic dimming feature 57 Interior rearview mirror, com‐

pass 139 Interior rearview mirror, man‐

ually dimmable 57 Internet page 6 Interval display, service re‐

quirements 82

Interval mode 69

JJacking points for the vehicle

jack 200 Joystick, Steptronic transmis‐

sion 72 Jump-starting 203

KKey/remote control 34 Keyless Go, refer to Comfort

Access 41 Key Memory, refer to Per‐

sonal Profile 35 Kickdown, Steptronic trans‐

mission 71 Knee airbag 96

LLamp replacement 193 Lamp replacement, front 194 Lamp replacement, rear 198 Lane departure warning 109 Lane margin, warning 109 Language on Control Dis‐

play 88 Lashing eyes, securing

cargo 156 LATCH child restraint sys‐

tem 61 Launch Control 74 Leather, care 210 LEDs, light-emitting di‐

odes 194 Letters and numbers, enter‐

ing 25 Light alloy wheels, care 210 Light control 91 Light-emitting diodes,

LEDs 194 Lighter 141 Lighting 90

Lights 90 Lights and bulbs 193 Light switch 90 Load 156 Loading 155 Lock, door 39 Locking/unlocking via door

lock 39 Locking/unlocking with re‐

mote control 37 Locking, automatic 43 Locking, settings 43 Locking via trunk lid 40 Low beams 90 Low beams, automatic, refer

to High-beam Assistant 92 Lower back support 50 Luggage rack, see Roof-

mounted luggage rack 157 Lumbar support 50

MMaintenance 191 Maintenance require‐

ments 191 Maintenance, service require‐

ments 82 Maintenance system,

BMW 191 Make-up mirror 141 Malfunction displays, see

Check Control 77 Manual air distribu‐

tion 131, 134 Manual air flow 131, 134 Manual mode, Steptronic

transmission 72 Manual operation, door

lock 39 Manual operation, exterior

mirrors 56 Manual operation, fuel filler

flap 168 Manual operation, Park Dis‐

tance Control PDC 121

Seite 222

Reference Everything from A to Z

222Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Manual operation, rearviewcamera 123

Manual transmission 71 Marking on approved

tires 179 Marking, run-flat tires 180 Master key, refer to Remote

control 34 Maximum cooling 133 Maximum speed, display 83 Maximum speed, winter

tires 179 Measure, units of 88 Medical kit 203 Memory, seat, mirror 55 Menu, EfficientDynamics 162 Menu in instrument clus‐

ter 84 Menus, operating, iDrive 18 Menus, refer to iDrive operat‐

ing concept 20 Messages, see Check Con‐

trol 77 Microfilter 132, 135 Minimum tread, tires 178 Mirror 55 Mirror memory 55 Mobile communication devi‐

ces in the vehicle 153 Mobility System 180 Modifications, technical, refer

to Safety 7 Moisture in headlight 194 Monitor, refer to Control Dis‐

play 18 Mounting of child restraint

systems 59 Multifunction steering wheel,

buttons 14

NNavigation, see user's manual

for Navigation, Entertain‐ment and Communication

Neck restraints, front, refer toHead restraints 53

Neck restraints, rear, refer toHead restraints 54

Neutral cleaner, see wheelcleaner 210

New wheels and tires 178 Nylon rope for tow-starting/

towing 206

OOBD Onboard Diagnosis 192 OBD, see OBD Onboard Di‐

agnosis 192 Obstacle marking, rearview

camera 124 Octane rating, refer to Rec‐

ommended fuel grade 170 Odometer 80 Office, see user's manual for

Navigation, Entertainmentand Communication

Oil 187 Oil, adding 188 Oil additives 188 Oil change 189 Oil change interval, service

requirements 82 Oil filler neck 188 Oil types, alternative 189 Oil types, approved 189 Old batteries, disposal 200 On-board computer 85 On-board computer, refer to

On-board computer 85 Onboard monitor, refer to

Control Display 18 Onboard vehicle tool kit 193 Opening/closing via door

lock 39 Opening and closing 34 Opening and closing, without

remote control 39 Opening and closing, with re‐

mote control 37

Operating concept, iDrive 18 Optional equipment, standard

equipment 6 Outside air, refer to Auto‐

matic recirculated-air con‐trol 134

Overheating of engine, referto Coolant temperature 80

PPaint, vehicle 209 Parallel parking assistant 125 Park Distance Control

PDC 120 Parked-car ventilation 136 Parked vehicle, condensa‐

tion 154 Parking aid, refer to PDC 120 Parking assistant 125 Parking brake 67 Parking lights 90 Parking lights, bulb replace‐

ment 196 Parts and accessories 7 Passenger side mirror, tilting

downward 56 Pathway lines, rearview cam‐

era 124 PDC Park Distance Con‐

trol 120 Pedestrian warning with city

braking function 107 Personal Profile 35 Personal Profile, exporting

profiles 36 Personal Profile, importing

profiles 37 Pinch protection system,

glass sunroof 47 Pinch protection system, win‐

dows 46 Plastic, care 210 Power failure 200 Power sunroof, glass 46 Power windows 45

Seite 223

Everything from A to Z Reference

223Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Pressure, tire air pres‐sure 172

Pressure warning, tires 102 Profile, refer to Personal Pro‐

file 35 Programmable memory but‐

tons, iDrive 24 Protective function, glass

sunroof 47 Protective function, win‐

dows 46 Push-and-turn switch, refer to

Controller 18, 19

RRadiator fluid 190 Radio-operated key, refer to

Remote control 34 Radio ready state 63 Radio, see user's manual for

Navigation, Entertainmentand Communication

Rain sensor 69 Rear lights 198 Rear socket 142 Rearview camera 123 Rearview mirror 55 Rear window de‐

froster 131, 134 Recirculated-air filter 135 Recirculated-air

mode 131, 134 Recommended fuel

grade 170 Recommended tire

brands 179 Refueling 168 Remaining range 81 Remote control/key 34 Remote control, malfunc‐

tion 38 Remote control, univer‐

sal 137 Replacement fuse 201 Replacing parts 193

Replacing wheels/tires 178 Reporting safety defects 9 RES button, see Cruise con‐

trol 118 Reserve warning, refer to

Range 81 Reset, Tire Pressure Monitor

TPM 99 Retaining straps, securing

cargo 156 Retreaded tires 179 Roadside parking lights 91 RON recommended fuel

grade 170 Roofliner 17 Roof load capacity 214 Roof-mounted luggage

rack 157 Rope for tow-starting/

towing 206 RSC Run Flat System Com‐

ponent, refer to Run-flattires 180

Rubber components,care 210

Run-flat tires 180

SSafe braking 153 Safety 7 Safety belt reminder for driv‐

er's seat and front passen‐ger seat 53

Safety belts 52 Safety belts, care 211 Safety systems, airbags 95 Saving fuel 158 Screen, refer to Control Dis‐

play 18 Screwdriver, see Onboard ve‐

hicle tool kit 193 Screw thread, see screw

thread for tow fitting, screwthread for tow fitting 207

Sealant 180

Seat and mirror memory 55 Seat belts, refer to Safety

belts 52 Seat heating, front 51 Seating position for chil‐

dren 59 Seats 48 Selection list in instrument

cluster 84 Selector lever, Steptronic

transmission 72 Sensors, care 211 Service and warranty 8 Service requirements, Condi‐

tion Based ServiceCBS 191

Service requirements, dis‐play 82

Services, ConnectedDrive Servotronic 114 SET button, see Cruise con‐

trol 118 Settings, locking/unlock‐

ing 43 Settings on Control Dis‐

play 87 Settings, storing for seat, mir‐

ror 55 Shift paddles on the steering

wheel 73 Side airbags 95 Signaling, horn 14 Signals when unlocking 43 Sitting safely 48 Size 214 Slide/tilt glass roof 46 Snow chains 183 Socket 141 Socket, OBD Onboard Diag‐

nostics 192 SOS button 202 Spare fuse 201 Specified engine oil

types 189 Speed, average 86

Seite 224

Reference Everything from A to Z

224Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Speed limit detection, on-board computer 86

Speed limiter, display 83 Speed Limit Information 83 Speed warning 87 Split screen 23 SPORT+ - program, Dynamic

Driving Control 115 Sport displays, torque dis‐

play, performance dis‐play 87

SPORT program, DynamicDriving Control 115

Sport program, transmis‐sion 72

Sport steering, variable 114 Stability control systems 112 Start/stop, automatic func‐

tion 65 Start/Stop button 63 Start function during malfunc‐

tion 35 Starting the engine 64 Status control display,

tires 99 Status information, iDrive 23 Status of Owner's Manual 7 Steering assistance 114 Steering wheel, adjusting 57 Steering wheel heating 58 Steptronic Sport transmis‐

sion, refer to Steptronictransmission 71

Steptronic transmission 71 Stopping the engine 64 Storage compartment in the

rear 147 Storage compartments 145 Storage, tires 180 Storing the vehicle 211 Suitable engine oils 189 Summer tires, tread 177 Sun visor 141 Supplementary text mes‐

sages 79

Switch for Dynamic Driv‐ing 114

Switch-on times, parked-carventilation 136

Switch, refer to Cockpit 14 Symbols 6 Symbols in the status field 23

TTachometer 80 Tail lights 198 Technical changes, refer to

Safety 7 Technical data 214 Telephone, see user's manual

for Navigation, Entertain‐ment and Communication

Temperature, automatic cli‐mate control 131, 133

Temperature display for ex‐ternal temperature 81

Terminal, starting aid 204 Text messages, supplemen‐

tary 79 Theft alarm system, refer to

Alarm system 44 Thigh support 50 Through-loading system 143 Tilt alarm sensor 44 Time of arrival 86 Tire damage 178 Tire identification marks 176 Tire inflation pressure 172 Tire inflation pressure moni‐

tor, refer to FTM 102 Tire Pressure Monitor

TPM 98 Tires, changing 178 Tire sealant 180 Tires, everything on wheels

and tires 172 Tires, run-flat tires 180 Tire tread 177

Tone, see user's manual forNavigation, Entertainmentand Communication

Tool 193 Total vehicle weight 214 Touchpad 21 Tow fitting 206 Towing 205 Tow lug, see Tow fitting 206 Tow-starting 205 Tow truck 205 TPM Tire Pressure Moni‐

tor 98 Traction control 113 TRACTION, driving dynam‐

ics 113 Transmission lock, electronic

unlocking 74 Transmission, manual trans‐

mission 71 Transmission, Steptronic

transmission 71 Transporting children

safely 59 Tread, tires 177 Trip computer 86 Triple turn signal activa‐

tion 68 Trip odometer 80 Truck for tow-starting/

towing 205 Trunk lid closing 40 Trunk lid, emergency unlock‐

ing 41 Trunk lid, hotel function 41 Trunk lid opening 40 Trunk lid via remote con‐

trol 38 Turning circle lines, rearview

camera 124 Turn signals, operation 67 Turn signals, rear, bulb re‐

placement 198

Seite 225

Everything from A to Z Reference

225Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

UUnintentional alarm 45 Units of measure 88 Universal remote control 137 Unlock button, Steptronic

transmission 72 Unlocking/locking via door

lock 39 Unlocking/locking with re‐

mote control 37 Unlocking, settings 43 Updates made after the edito‐

rial deadline 7 Upholstery care 210 USB interface 142

VVanity mirror 141 Variable sport steering 114 Vehicle battery 200 Vehicle battery, replac‐

ing 200 Vehicle, break-in 152 Vehicle care 209 Vehicle features and op‐

tions 6 Vehicle identification num‐

ber 9 Vehicle jack 200 Vehicle paint 209 Vehicle storage 211 Vehicle wash 208 Ventilation 135 Ventilation, refer to Parked-

car ventilation 136 VIN, see vehicle identification

number 9 Voice activation system 27

WWarning and indicator lamps,

see Check Control 77

Warning displays, see CheckControl 77

Warning messages, seeCheck Control 77

Warning triangle 203 Warranty 7 Washer fluid 70 Washer nozzles, wind‐

shield 70 Washer system 68 Washing, vehicle 208 Water on roads 153 Weights 214 Welcome lamps during un‐

locking 37 Welcome lights 90 Wheel cleaner 210 Wheels, changing 178 Wheels, everything on wheels

and tires 172 Wheels, Flat Tire Monitor

FTM 102 Wheels, Tire Pressure Moni‐

tor TPM 98 Window defroster,

rear 131, 134 Windows, powered 45 Windshield washer fluid 70 Windshield washer noz‐

zles 70 Windshield washer sys‐

tem 68 Windshield wiper 68 Winter storage, care 211 Winter tires, suitable

tires 179 Winter tires, tread 177 Wiper 68 Wiper blades, replacing 193 Wiper fluid 70 Wiper, fold-out position 70 Wiper system 68 Wood, care 210 Word match concept, naviga‐

tion 25

Wrench, see Onboard vehicletool kit 193

XxDrive 113 Xenon headlights, bulb re‐

placement 196

Seite 226

Reference Everything from A to Z

226Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by:

Information Provided by:

More about BMW

bmwusa.comThe Ultimate

Driving Machine®

01 4

0 2

961

270

ue

*BL296127000T*

Online Edition for Part no. 01 40 2 961 270 - II/15

Information Provided by: